Lexmark CX730DE

Product's Documents

Below are documents related to this product, you can read online or download:
Other Documents Installation Instruction
  • Common Criteria Installation Supplement and Administrator Guide PDF - (English) Download
Specification
  • Technical White Paper Revision 3a - (English) Download
  • Forms and Bar Code Card P4.2 Technical Reference - (English) Download
CX730DE photo

User's Guide PDF

This is the main product document for model CX730DE.

The file format is pdf, 366 pages, you can download this manual here .

background
CX730, CX735, CX737, XC4342,
XC4352 MFPs
User's Guide
July 2024 www.lexmark.com
Machine type:
7530
Models:
236, 239, 678, 679, 878
background
Contents
Safety information........................................................................................ 6
Conventions.......................................................................................................................................................... 6
Product statements............................................................................................................................................. 6
Learn about the printer................................................................................ 9
Finding information about the printer.............................................................................................................9
Finding the printer serial number...................................................................................................................10
Printer configurations........................................................................................................................................10
Using the control panel......................................................................................................................................11
Understanding the status of the indicator light..........................................................................................12
Selecting paper...................................................................................................................................................12
Set up, install, and configure.................................................................... 20
Selecting a location for the printer............................................................................................................... 20
Attaching cables.................................................................................................................................................21
Setting up and using the home screen applications...............................................................................22
Setting up and using the accessibility features.........................................................................................28
Setting up the printer to fax............................................................................................................................33
Configuring the email SMTP settings......................................................................................................... 40
Loading paper and specialty media............................................................................................................. 48
Installing and updating software, drivers, and firmware......................................................................... 54
Installing hardware options............................................................................................................................ 58
Networking..........................................................................................................................................................97
Setting up serial printing (Windows only)..................................................................................................100
Secure the printer......................................................................................101
Locating the security slot................................................................................................................................101
Erasing printer memory...................................................................................................................................101
Erasing printer storage drive......................................................................................................................... 101
Restoring factory default settings................................................................................................................102
Statement of Volatility.....................................................................................................................................102
Print.............................................................................................................103
Printing from a computer............................................................................................................................... 103
Printing from a mobile device.......................................................................................................................103
Contents 2
background
Printing from a flash drive..............................................................................................................................105
Supported flash drives and file types.........................................................................................................106
Configuring confidential jobs....................................................................................................................... 106
Printing confidential and other held jobs...................................................................................................107
Printing a font sample list.............................................................................................................................. 108
Printing a directory list....................................................................................................................................108
Placing separator sheets between copies................................................................................................108
Canceling a print job.......................................................................................................................................108
Adjusting toner darkness...............................................................................................................................108
Copy............................................................................................................109
Using the automatic document feeder and scanner glass...................................................................109
Making copies.................................................................................................................................................. 109
Copying photos................................................................................................................................................109
Copying on letterhead.....................................................................................................................................110
Copying on both sides of the paper............................................................................................................110
Reducing or enlarging copies....................................................................................................................... 110
Collating copies.................................................................................................................................................110
Placing separator sheets between copies.................................................................................................110
Copying multiple pages onto a single sheet..............................................................................................111
Copying cards.....................................................................................................................................................111
Creating a copy shortcut..................................................................................................................................111
E-mail...........................................................................................................112
Using the automatic document feeder and scanner glass....................................................................112
Sending an e-mail............................................................................................................................................. 112
Creating an e-mail shortcut............................................................................................................................112
Fax............................................................................................................... 113
Using the automatic document feeder and scanner glass....................................................................113
Sending a fax..................................................................................................................................................... 113
Scheduling a fax................................................................................................................................................114
Creating a fax destination shortcut.............................................................................................................. 114
Changing the fax resolution...........................................................................................................................114
Adjusting the fax darkness.............................................................................................................................114
Printing a fax log............................................................................................................................................... 115
Blocking junk faxes...........................................................................................................................................115
Contents 3
background
Holding faxes..................................................................................................................................................... 115
Forwarding a fax............................................................................................................................................... 115
Scan............................................................................................................. 117
Using the automatic document feeder and scanner glass.................................................................... 117
Scanning to a computer.................................................................................................................................. 117
Scanning to an FTP server............................................................................................................................. 118
Creating an FTP shortcut................................................................................................................................118
Scanning to a network folder........................................................................................................................ 119
Creating a network folder shortcut.............................................................................................................. 119
Scanning to a flash drive............................................................................................................................... 120
Use printer menus..................................................................................... 121
Menu map........................................................................................................................................................... 121
Device.................................................................................................................................................................122
Print......................................................................................................................................................................138
Paper................................................................................................................................................................... 146
Copy.................................................................................................................................................................... 149
Fax....................................................................................................................................................................... 152
E-mail...................................................................................................................................................................168
FTP....................................................................................................................................................................... 174
USB Drive...........................................................................................................................................................178
Network/Ports................................................................................................................................................... 183
Security...............................................................................................................................................................196
Cloud Services................................................................................................................................................ 204
Reports.............................................................................................................................................................. 204
Troubleshooting.............................................................................................................................................. 206
Printing the Menu Settings Page................................................................................................................206
Maintain the printer................................................................................. 207
Checking the status of parts and supplies...............................................................................................207
Configuring supply notifications................................................................................................................. 207
Setting up email alerts..................................................................................................................................207
Viewing reports...............................................................................................................................................208
Ordering parts and supplies........................................................................................................................ 208
Replacing parts and supplies.........................................................................................................................211
Cleaning printer parts....................................................................................................................................249
Contents 4
background
Saving energy and paper.............................................................................................................................. 261
Moving the printer to another location...................................................................................................... 261
Shipping the printer....................................................................................................................................... 262
Troubleshoot a problem.......................................................................... 263
Print quality problems....................................................................................................................................263
Printer error codes..........................................................................................................................................264
Printing problems............................................................................................................................................273
The printer is not responding...................................................................................................................... 304
Unable to read flash drive............................................................................................................................305
Enabling the USB port...................................................................................................................................306
Clearing jams................................................................................................................................................... 306
Network connection problems.....................................................................................................................316
Hardware options problems......................................................................................................................... 318
Issues with supplies........................................................................................................................................ 321
Paper feed problems..................................................................................................................................... 323
E-mailing problems.........................................................................................................................................325
Faxing problems..............................................................................................................................................326
Scanning problems.........................................................................................................................................332
Color quality problems.................................................................................................................................. 339
Contacting customer support....................................................................................................................... 341
Recycle and dispose................................................................................ 342
Recycling Lexmark products........................................................................................................................342
Recycling Lexmark packaging.....................................................................................................................342
Notices....................................................................................................... 343
Index...........................................................................................................359
Contents 5
background
Safety information
Conventions
Note: A note identifies information that could help you.
Warning: A warning identifies something that could damage the product hardware or software.
WARNING (in full capitals): A WARNING indicates a risk of death or serious injury if not avoided.
CAUTION: A caution indicates a potentially hazardous situation that could injure you.
Dierent types of caution statements include:
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Indicates a risk of injury.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: Indicates a risk of electrical shock.
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: Indicates a risk of burn if touched.
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Indicates a crush hazard.
CAUTION—PINCH HAZARD: Indicates a risk of being caught between moving parts.
Product statements
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord to
an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, use only the power cord
provided with this product or the manufacturer's authorized replacement.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Do not use this product with extension cords, multioutlet power strips,
multioutlet extenders, or UPS devices. The power capacity of these types of accessories can be easily
overloaded by a laser printer and may result in a risk of fire, property damage, or poor printer
performance.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Only a Lexmark Inline Surge Protector that is properly connected
between the printer and the power cord provided with the printer may be used with this product. The
use of non-Lexmark surge protection devices may result in a risk of fire, property damage, or poor
printer performance.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of fire, use only a 26 AWG or larger
telecommunications (RJ-11) cord when connecting this product to the public switched telephone
network. For users in Australia, the cord must be approved by the Australian Communications and Media
Authority.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, do not place or use this product near
water or wet locations.
Safety information 6
background
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, do not set up this product or make
any electrical or cabling connections, such as the power cord, fax feature, or telephone, during a
lightning storm.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Do not cut, twist, bind, crush, or place heavy objects on the power
cord. Do not subject the power cord to abrasion or stress. Do not pinch the power cord between objects
such as furniture and walls. If any of these things happen, a risk of fire or electrical shock results. Inspect
the power cord regularly for signs of such problems. Remove the power cord from the electrical outlet
before inspecting it.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, make sure that all external
connections (such as Ethernet and telephone system connections) are properly installed in their marked
plug-in ports.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, if you are accessing the controller
board or installing optional hardware or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn
the printer o, and unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any
other devices attached to the printer, then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the
printer.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, do not use the fax feature during a
lightning storm.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock when cleaning the exterior of the
printer, unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet and disconnect all cables from the printer before
proceeding.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: If the printer weight is greater than 20 kg (44 lb), then it may require
two or more people to lift it safely.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: When moving the printer, follow these guidelines to avoid personal
injury or printer damage:
Make sure that all doors and trays are closed.
Turn o the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
Disconnect all cords and cables from the printer.
If the printer has separate floor-standing optional trays or output options attached to it, then disconnect
them before moving the printer.
If the printer has a caster base, then carefully roll it to the new location. Use caution when passing over
thresholds and breaks in
flooring.
If the printer does not have a caster base but is configured with optional trays or output options, then remove
the output options and lift the printer
o
the trays. Do not try to lift the printer and any options at the same
time.
Always use the handholds on the printer to lift it.
Any cart used to move the printer must have a surface able to support the full footprint of the printer.
Any cart used to move the hardware options must have a surface able to support the dimensions of the
options.
Keep the printer in an upright position.
Avoid severe jarring movements.
Make sure that your fingers are not under the printer when you set it down.
Make sure that there is adequate clearance around the printer.
Safety information 7
background
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Installing one or more options on your printer or MFP may require a
caster base, furniture, or other feature to prevent instability causing possible injury. For more information
on supported configurations, see
www.lexmark.com/multifunctionprinters.
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: To reduce the risk of equipment instability, load each tray separately.
Keep all other trays closed until needed.
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a hot
component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.
CAUTION—PINCH HAZARD: To avoid the risk of a pinch injury, use caution in areas marked with this
label. Pinch injuries may occur around moving parts, such as gears, doors, trays, and covers.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: This product uses a laser. Use of controls or adjustments or
performance of procedures other than those specified in the User’s Guide may result in hazardous
radiation exposure.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The lithium battery in this product is not intended to be replaced.
There is a danger of explosion if a lithium battery is incorrectly replaced. Do not recharge, disassemble,
or incinerate a lithium battery. Discard used lithium batteries according to the manufacturer's instructions
and local regulations.
INGESTION HAZARD: This product contains a button cell or coin battery.
DEATH or serious injury can occur if ingested.
A swallowed button cell or coin battery can cause Internal Chemical Burns in as little
as 2 hours.
KEEP new and used batteries OUT OF REACH of CHILDREN.
Seek immediate medical attention if a battery is suspected to be swallowed or inserted
inside any part of the body.
Remove and immediately recycle or dispose of used batteries according to local regulations and keep away
from children. Do not dispose of batteries in household trash or incinerate. Even used batteries may cause
severe injury or death. Call a local poison control center for treatment information.
Battery type: CR6821
Nominal battery voltage: 3V
Do not force discharge, recharge, disassemble, heat above 60°C (140°F), or incinerate. Doing so may result
in injury due to venting, leakage, or explosion resulting in chemical burns.
This equipment is not suitable for use in locations where children are likely to be present.
This product is designed, tested, and approved to meet strict global safety standards with the use of specific
manufacturer's components. The safety features of some parts may not always be obvious. The manufacturer
is not responsible for the use of other replacement parts.
Refer service or repairs, other than those described in the user documentation, to a service representative.
SAVE THESE INSTRUCTIONS.
Safety information 8
background
Learn about the printer
Finding information about the printer
What are you looking for? Find it here
Initial setup instructions See the setup documentation that came with the
printer.
Printer software
Print or fax driver
Printer firmware
Utility
Go to
www.lexmark.com/downloads, search for
your printer model, and then in the Type menu,
select the driver,
firmware,
or utility that you need.
Selecting and storing paper and specialty media
Loading paper
Configuring printer settings
Viewing and printing documents and photos
Configuring the printer on a network
Caring for and maintaining the printer
Troubleshooting and solving problems
Information Center—Go to
https://infoserve.lexmark.com.
Howto videos—Go to
https://infoserve.lexmark.com/idv/.
Touch Screen Guide—Go to
http://support.lexmark.com.
Setting up and configuring the accessibility features of your
printer
Lexmark Accessibility Guide—Go to
http://support.lexmark.com.
Help information for using the printer software. Help for Microsoft Windows or Macintosh operating
systems—Open a printer software program or
application, and then click Help.
Click
?
to view contextsensitive information.
Notes:
Help is automatically installed with the printer
software.
Depending on the operating system, the
printer software is either in the printer
program folder or on the desktop.
Learn about the printer 9
background
What are you looking for? Find it here
Documentation
Live chat support
Email support
Voice support
Go to
http://support.lexmark.com.
Note: Select your country or region, and then
select your product to view the appropriate
support site.
Support contact information for your country or
region can be found on the website or on the
printed warranty that came with the printer.
Have the following information ready when you
contact customer support:
Place and date of purchase
Machine type and serial number
For more information, see
“Finding the printer
serial number” on page 10.
Safety information
Regulatory information
Warranty information
Environmental information
Warranty information varies by country or region:
In the U.S.—See the Statement of Limited
Warranty included with the printer, or go to
http://support.lexmark.com.
In other countries and regions—See the
printed warranty that came with the printer.
Product Information Guide—See the
documentation that came with the printer or go to
http://support.lexmark.com.
Information on Lexmark digital passport Go to
https://csr.lexmark.com/digital-
passport.php.
Finding the printer serial number
1 Open door A.
2 Locate the serial number.
Printer configurations
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Installing one or more options on your printer or MFP may require a
caster base, furniture, or other feature to prevent instability causing possible injury. For more information
on supported configurations, see
www.lexmark.com/multifunctionprinters.
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: To reduce the risk of equipment instability, load each tray separately.
Keep all other trays closed until needed.
Learn about the printer 10
background
You can configure your printer by adding four optional 550sheet trays.
1 ADF tray
2 ADF bin
3 Control panel
4 650sheet duo tray
Note: The tray is composed of a 550sheet tray and a 100sheet multipurpose feeder.
5 Optional 550sheet trays
6 Standard bin
7 Automatic document feeder (ADF)
Using the control panel
Learn about the printer 11
background
Control panel part Function
1 Power button
Turn on or turn o the printer.
Note: To tur n
o
the printer, press and hold the power button for
five
seconds.
Set the printer to Sleep mode.
Wake the printer from Sleep or Hibernate mode.
2 Display
View the printer messages and supply status.
Set up and operate the printer.
3 Indicator light Check the status of the printer.
Understanding the status of the indicator light
Indicator light Printer status
O The printer is o.
Solid blue The printer is ready.
Blinking blue The printer is printing or processing data.
Blinking red The printer requires user intervention.
Solid amber The printer is in Sleep mode.
Blinking amber The printer is in Deep Sleep or Hibernate mode.
Selecting paper
Paper guidelines
Use the appropriate paper to prevent jams and help ensure troublefree printing.
Always use new, undamaged paper.
Before loading paper, know the recommended printable side of the paper. This information is usually
indicated on the paper package.
Do not use paper that has been cut or trimmed by hand.
Do not mix paper sizes, types, or weights in the same tray; mixing results in jams.
Do not use coated papers unless they are specifically designed for electrophotographic printing.
For more information, see the Paper and Specialty Media Guide.
Paper characteristics
The following paper characteristics aect print quality and reliability. Consider these factors before printing on
them.
Learn about the printer 12
background
Weight
Trays can feed paper of varying weights. Paper lighter than 60 g/m
2
(16 lb) may not be
sti
enough to feed
properly, and may cause jams. For more information, see the “Supported paper weights” topic.
Curl
Curl is the tendency for paper to curl at its edges. Excessive curl can cause paper feeding problems. Curl can
occur after the paper passes through the printer, where it is exposed to high temperatures. Storing paper
unwrapped in hot, humid, cold, or dry conditions can contribute to paper curling before printing and can cause
feeding problems.
Smoothness
Paper smoothness directly aects print quality. If paper is too rough, toner cannot fuse to it properly. If paper
is too smooth, it can cause paper feeding or print quality issues. We recommend the use of paper with 50
Sheeld
points.
Moisture content
The amount of moisture in paper aects both print quality and the printer ability to feed the paper correctly.
Leave paper in its original wrapper until you use it. Exposure of paper to moisture changes can degrade its
performance.
Before printing, store paper in its original wrapper for 24 to 48 hours. The environment in which the paper is
stored must be the same as the printer . Extend the time several days if the storage or transportation
environment is very dierent from the printer environment. Thick paper may also require a longer conditioning
period.
Grain direction
Grain refers to the alignment of the paper fibers in a sheet of paper. Grain is either grain long which runs the
length of the paper, or grain short which runs the width of the paper. For recommended grain direction, see the
“Supported paper weights” topic.
Fiber content
Most highquality xerographic paper is made from 100 percent chemically treated pulped wood. This content
provides the paper with a high degree of stability, resulting in fewer paper feeding problems and better print
quality. Paper containing fibers such as cotton can negatively aect paper handling.
Unacceptable paper
The following paper types are not recommended for use with the printer:
Chemically treated papers that are used to make copies without carbon paper. They are also known as
carbonless papers, carbonless copy paper (CCP), or no carbon required (NCR) paper.
Preprinted papers with chemicals that may contaminate the printer.
Preprinted papers that can be aected by the temperature in the printer fuser.
Preprinted papers that require a registration (the precise print location on the page) greater than ±2.3 mm
(±0.09 in.). For example, optical character recognition (OCR) forms.
Sometimes, registration can be adjusted with a software app to print successfully on these forms.
Coated papers (erasable bond), synthetic papers, or thermal papers.
Learn about the printer 13
background
Roughedged, rough or heavily textured surface papers, or curled papers.
Papers that fail EN12281:2002 (European).
Paper weighing less than 60 g/m
2
(16 lb).
Multiplepart forms or documents.
Storing paper
Use these paper storage guidelines to help avoid jams and uneven print quality:
Store paper in its original wrapper in the same environment as the printer for 24 to 48 hours before printing.
Extend the time several days if the storage or transportation environment is very dierent from the printer
environment. Thick paper may also require a longer conditioning period.
For best results, store paper where the temperature is 21°C (70°F) and the relative humidity is 40 percent.
Most label manufacturers recommend printing in a temperature range of 18–24°C (65–75°F) with relative
humidity between 40 and 60 percent.
Store paper in cartons, on a pallet or shelf, rather than on the floor.
Store individual packages on a flat surface.
Do not store anything on top of individual paper packages.
Take paper out of the carton or wrapper only when you are ready to load it in the printer. The carton and
wrapper help keep the paper clean, dry, and flat.
Selecting preprinted forms and letterhead
Use grain long paper.
Use only forms and letterhead printed using an oset lithographic or engraved printing process.
Avoid paper with rough or heavily textured surfaces.
Use inks that are not aected by the resin in toner. Inks that are oxidationset or oilbased generally meet
these requirements; latex inks might not.
Print samples on preprinted forms and letterheads considered for use before buying large quantities. This
action determines whether the ink in the preprinted form or letterhead aects print quality.
When in doubt, contact your paper supplier.
When printing on letterhead, load the paper in the proper orientation for your printer. For more information,
see the Paper and Specialty Media Guide.
Learn about the printer 14
background
Supported paper sizes
Paper size
650sheet duo tray
Optional
550sheet
tray
Twosided
printing
Scanner ADF
550sheet
tray
100sheet
multipurpose
feeder
1
A4
210 x 297 mm
(8.27 x 11.7 in.)
A5 landscape
2
210 x 148 mm
(8.27 x 5.83 in.)
A5 portrait
2
148 x 210 mm
(5.83 x 8.27 in.)
A6
105 x 148 mm
(4.13 x 5.83 in.)
Banner
215.9 x 1320.8 mm
(8.5 x 52 in.)
X XXXX
Executive
184.2 x 266.7 mm
(7.25 x 10.5 in.)
Folio
215.9 x 330.2 mm
(8.5 x 13 in.)
Hagaki
100 x 148 mm
(3.94 x 5.83 in.)
X XX X
JIS B5
182 x 257 mm
(7.17 x 10.1 in.)
1
Does not support automatic size sensing.
2
Supported in both the portrait and landscape orientations. When fed in the portrait orientation, A5 is treated as
narrow paper. When fed in landscape orientation, it is treated as a regular width paper.
3
When Universal is selected, the page is formatted for 215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 in.) unless the size is specified
by the software application.
4
Load narrow paper in portrait orientation.
5
When Other Envelope is selected, the page is formatted for 215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 in.) unless a size is specified
by the software application.
Learn about the printer 15
background
Paper size
650sheet duo tray
Optional
550sheet
tray
Twosided
printing
Scanner ADF
550sheet
tray
100sheet
multipurpose
feeder
1
Legal
215.9 x 355.6 mm
(8.5 x 14 in.)
Letter
215.9 x 279.4 mm
(8.5 x 11 in.)
Oficio (Mexico)
216 x 340 mm
(8.5 x 13.4 in.)
Statement
139.7 x 215.9 mm
(5.5 x 8.5 in.)
Universal
3, 4
76.2 x 127 mm to 215.9
x 355.6 mm
(3 x 5 in. to 8.5 x 14 in.)
X
XX X
Universal
3, 4
105 x 148 mm to 215.9
x 355.6 mm
(4.13 x 5.83 in. to 8.5 x
14 in.)
X
7 3/4 Envelope
98.4 x 190.5 mm
(3.875 x 7.5 in.)
X
XX X
9 Envelope
98.4 x 225.4 mm
(3.875 x 8.9 in.)
X
XX X
10 Envelope
104.8 x 241.3 mm
(4.12 x 9.5 in.)
X X
1
Does not support automatic size sensing.
2
Supported in both the portrait and landscape orientations. When fed in the portrait orientation, A5 is treated as
narrow paper. When fed in landscape orientation, it is treated as a regular width paper.
3
When Universal is selected, the page is formatted for 215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 in.) unless the size is
specified
by the software application.
4
Load narrow paper in portrait orientation.
5
When Other Envelope is selected, the page is formatted for 215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 in.) unless a size is specified
by the software application.
Learn about the printer 16
background
Paper size
650sheet duo tray
Optional
550sheet
tray
Twosided
printing
Scanner ADF
550sheet
tray
100sheet
multipurpose
feeder
1
11 Envelope
114.3 x 263.525 mm
(4.5 x 10.375 in.)
X X
12 Envelope
120.65 x 279.4 mm
(4.75 x 11 in.)
X X
B5 Envelope
176 x 250 mm
(6.93 x 9.84 in.)
X X
B6 Envelope
125 x 176 mm
(4.92 x 6.92 in.)
X X
C5 Envelope
162 x 229 mm
(6.38 x 9.01 in.)
X X
C6 Envelope
114 x 162 mm
(4.48 x 6.37 in.)
X X
DL Envelope
110 x 220 mm
(4.33 x 8.66 in.)
X X
Monarch
98.4 x 190.5 mm
(3.875 x 7.5 in.)
X
XX X
Other Envelope
5
98.4 x 162 mm to 176
x 250 mm
(3.87 x 6.38 in. to 6.93
x 9.84 in.)
X
XX X
1
Does not support automatic size sensing.
2
Supported in both the portrait and landscape orientations. When fed in the portrait orientation, A5 is treated as
narrow paper. When fed in landscape orientation, it is treated as a regular width paper.
3
When Universal is selected, the page is formatted for 215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 in.) unless the size is specified
by the software application.
4
Load narrow paper in portrait orientation.
5
When Other Envelope is selected, the page is formatted for 215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 in.) unless a size is specified
by the software application.
Learn about the printer 17
background
Supported paper types
Paper type
650sheet duo tray
Optional
550sheet
tray
Twosided
printing
Scanner ADF
550sheet
tray
100sheet
multipurpose
feeder
Plain
Card stock X
Recycled
Glossy X
Labels
X
Vinyl Labels
X X
Bond
Envelope X X
Letterhead
Preprinted
Colored Paper
Light
Heavy
Rough/Cotton
TransparencyXXXXXX
Custom Type [x]
Notes:
Labels, envelopes, and card stock always print at reduced speed.
Card stock is supported in twosided printing only up to 163 g/m
2
(90lb index). Anything heavier is
supported only in onesided printing.
Vinyl labels are supported for occasional use only and must be tested for acceptability. Some vinyl labels
may feed more reliably from the multipurpose feeder.
Learn about the printer 18
background
Supported paper weights
650sheet duo tray
Optional 550sheet tray Twosided printing ADF
550sheet tray 100sheet multipurpose feeder
60–218 g/m
2
(16–58lb bond)
60–218 g/m
2
(16–58lb bond)
60–218 g/m
2
(16–58lb bond)
60–162 g/m
2
(16–43lb bond)
52–120 g/m
2
(14–32lb bond)
Paper type Paper weight
Plain Paper
75–90.3 g/m
2
(20–24 lb bond)
Glossy
88–176 g/m
2
(60–120 lb book)
162–176 g/m
2
grain long (60–65 lb cover)
Heavy Paper
90.3–105 g/m
2
grain long (24.1–28 lb bond)
Card stock
Up to 199 g/m
2
grain long (110 lb index)
Up to 218 g/m
2
grain short (80 lb cover)
Labels
Up to 218 g/m
2
(58 lb bond)
Envelopes
60–105 g/m
2
(16–28 lb bond)
Notes:
For 60 to 176 g/m
2
(16–47lb bond) paper, grain long
fibers
are recommended.
Paper less than 75 g/m
2
(20lb bond) must be printed with Paper Type set to Light Paper. Failure to do so
may cause excessive curl which can lead to feeding errors, especially in more humid environments.
Twosided printing supports paper weight from 60-162 g/m
2
(16–43lb bond) paper.
100% cotton content maximum weight is 90 g/m
2
(24lb bond).
Learn about the printer 19
background
Set up, install, and
configure
Selecting a location for the printer
Leave enough room to open trays, covers, and doors and to install hardware options.
Set up the printer near an electrical outlet.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of
fire
or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, do not place or use this product
near water or wet locations.
Make sure that airflow in the room meets the latest revision of the ASHRAE 62 standard or the CEN Technical
Committee 156 standard.
Provide a
flat,
sturdy, and stable surface.
Keep the printer:
Clean, dry, and free of dust.
Away from stray staples and paper clips.
Away from the direct airflow of air conditioners, heaters, or ventilators.
Free from direct sunlight and humidity extremes.
Observe the recommended temperatures and avoid fluctuations:
Ambient temperature 10 to 32.2°C (50 to 90°F)
Storage temperature 15.6 to 32.2°C (60 to 90°F)
Allow the following recommended amount of space around the printer for proper ventilation:
Set up, install, and configure 20
background
1 Top 229 mm (9 in.)
2 Rear 101.6 mm (4 in.)
3 Right side 178 mm (7 in.)
4 Front 508 mm (20 in.)
5 Left side 127 mm (5 in.)
Attaching cables
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, do not set up this product or make
any electrical or cabling connections, such as the power cord, fax feature, or telephone, during a
lightning storm.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord to
an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of
fire
or electrical shock, use only the power cord
provided with this product or the manufacturer's authorized replacement.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of fire, use only a 26 AWG or larger
telecommunications (RJ-11) cord when connecting this product to the public switched telephone
network. For users in Australia, the cord must be approved by the Australian Communications and Media
Authority.
Warning—Potential Damage: To avoid loss of data or printer malfunction, do not touch the USB cable, any
wireless network adapter, or the printer in the areas shown while actively printing.
Printer port Function
1 Power cord socket Connect the printer to a properly grounded electrical outlet.
2 LINE port
Note: Available only in some
printer models.
Connect the printer to an active telephone line through a standard wall
jack (RJ11), DSL filter, or VoIP adapter, or any other adapter that allows
you to access the telephone line to send and receive faxes.
Set up, install, and configure 21
background
Printer port Function
3 Ethernet port Connect the printer to a network.
4 USB printer port Connect the printer to a computer.
5 USB port Attach a keyboard or any compatible option.
Setting up and using the home screen applications
Using the home screen
Note: Your home screen may vary depending on your home screen customization settings, administrative
setup, and active embedded solutions.
#Icon Function
1 Stop or Cancel button Stop the current job.
2 Copy Make copies.
3 Change Language Change the language on the printer display.
4 Email Send emails.
5 Settings Access the printer menus.
6 Fax Send fax.
7 Address Book Access, create, and organize contacts.
8 Status/Supplies
Show a printer warning or error message whenever the printer requires
intervention to continue processing.
View more information on the printer warning or message, and on how to clear
it.
Note: You can also access this setting by touching the top section of the home
screen.
Set up, install, and configure 22
background
#Icon Function
9 Held Jobs Show all the current held print jobs
10 Job Queue Show all the current print jobs.
Note: You can also access this setting by touching the top section of the home
screen.
11 USB Drive View, select, or print photos and documents from a flash drive.
12 Scan Profiles Scan and save documents directly to the computer.
13 FTP Scan and save documents directly to an FTP server.
14 Bookmarks Organize all bookmarks.
15 Hard Disk View, select, and manage documents from a hard drive or an intelligent storage drive.
16 Network Folder Scan to a network folder or network location.
17 Start button Start a job, depending on which mode is selected.
18 Onscreen keypad Enter numbers or symbols in an input field.
Customizing the home screen
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Device > Home Screen Customization.
3 Do one or more of the following:
To add an icon to the home screen, click , select the app name, and then click Add.
To remove a home screen icon, select the app name, and then click Remove.
To customize an app name, select the app name, click Edit, and then assign a name.
To restore the name of an app, select the app name, click Edit, and then select Restore app label.
To add a space between apps, click , select BLANK SPACE, and then click Add.
To arrange the apps, drag the app names in the order that you want.
To restore the default home screen, click Restore home screen.
4 Apply the changes.
Supported applications
Application Printer models
Scan Center CX730, CX735, XC4342, XC4352
Shortcut Center CX730, CX735, XC4342, XC4352
Card Copy CX730, CX735, XC4342, XC4352
Set up, install, and configure 23
background
Application Printer models
Display Customization CX730, CX735, XC4342, XC4352
Customer Support XC4342, XC4352
Device Quotas XC4342, XC4352
Setting up Scan Center
1 From the home screen, touch Scan Center.
2 Select and create a destination, and then configure the settings.
Notes:
When creating a network destination, make sure to validate and adjust the settings until no errors
occur.
Only destinations created from the Embedded Web Server are saved. For more information, see the
documentation that came with the solution.
3 Apply the changes.
Creating a shortcut
1 From the home screen, touch Shortcut Center.
Note: The icon and name may have been changed. For more information, contact your administrator.
2 Select a printer function, and then touch Create Shortcut.
Note: The Secure Email function is not supported.
3 Configure the settings, and then touch Save.
4 Type a unique shortcut name.
Note: To avoid clipped names on the home screen, type only up to 25 characters.
5 Touch OK.
The application automatically generates a unique shortcut number.
Note: To launch the shortcut, touch
, touch #, and then enter the shortcut number.
Setting up Card Copy
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address
field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Apps > Card Copy > Configure.
Set up, install, and configure 24
background
Notes:
Make sure that Display Icon is enabled.
Make sure that Email Settings and Network Share Settings are configured.
When scanning a card, make sure that the scan resolution does not exceed 200 dpi for color and
400 dpi for black and white.
When scanning multiple cards, make sure that the scan resolution does not exceed 150 dpi for color
and 300 dpi for black and white.
3 Apply the changes.
Note: You need a printer hard disk or an intelligent storage drive to scan multiple cards.
Using Display Customization
Before using the application, make sure to do the following:
From the Embedded Web Server, click Apps > Display Customization > Configure.
Enable and configure the screen saver, slideshow, and wallpaper settings.
Managing screen saver and slide show images
1
From the Screen Saver and Slideshow Images section, add, edit, or delete an image.
Notes:
You can add up to 10 images.
When enabled, the status icons appear on the screen saver only when there are errors, warnings, or
cloudbased notifications.
2 Apply the changes.
Changing the wallpaper image
1
From the home screen, touch Change Wallpaper.
2 Select an image to use.
3 Apply the changes.
Running a slide show from a
flash
drive
1
Insert a flash drive into the USB port.
2 From the home screen, touch Slideshow.
Images appear in alphabetical order.
Note: You c a n r e mo v e t h e
flash
drive after the slide show starts, but the images are not stored in the
printer. If the slide show stops, then insert the
flash
drive again to view the images.
Using Customer Support
Notes:
This application is supported only in some printer models. For more information, see “Supported
applications” on page 23.
Set up, install, and configure 25
background
For information on how to configure the application settings, see the Customer Support Administrator’s
Guide.
1 From the home screen, touch Customer Support.
2 Print or email the information.
Setting up Device Quotas
Notes:
This application is supported only in some printer models. For more information, see “Supported
applications” on page 23.
For information on how to configure the application settings, see the Device Quotas Administrator’s
Guide.
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address
field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Apps > Device Quotas >
Configure
.
3 In the User Accounts section, add or edit a user, and then set the user quota.
4 Apply the changes.
Managing bookmarks
Creating bookmarks
Use bookmarks to print frequently accessed documents that are stored in servers or on the web.
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Bookmarks > Add Bookmark, and then type a bookmark name.
3 Select an Address protocol type, and then do one of the following:
For HTTP and HTTPS, type the URL that you want to bookmark.
For HTTPS, make sure to use the host name instead of the IP address. For example, type
myWebsite.com/sample.pdf instead of typing 123.123.123.123/sample.pdf. Make sure that
the host name also matches the Common Name (CN) value in the server
certificate.
For more information
on obtaining the CN value in the server certificate, see the help information for your web browser.
For FTP, type the FTP address. For example, myServer/myDirectory. Enter the FTP port number.
Port 21 is the default port for sending commands.
Set up, install, and configure 26
background
For SMB, type the network folder address. For example, myServer/myShare/myFile.pdf. Type the
network domain name.
If necessary, select the Authentication type for FTP and SMB.
To limit access to the bookmark, enter a PIN.
Note: The application supports the following
file
types: PDF, JPEG, and TIFF. Other
file
types such as
DOCX and XLSX are supported in some printer models.
4 Click Save.
Creating folders
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Bookmarks > Add Folder, and then type a folder name.
Note: To limit access to the folder, enter a PIN.
3 Click Save.
Note: You can create folders or bookmarks inside a folder. To create a bookmark, see
“Creating bookmarks”
on page 26.
Managing contacts
1 From the home screen, touch Address Book.
2 Do one or more of the following:
To add a contact, touch on top of the screen, and then touch Create Contact. If necessary, specify a
login method to allow application access.
To delete a contact, touch on top of the screen, touch Delete Contacts, and then select the contact.
To edit contact information, touch the contact name.
To create a group, touch on top of the screen, and then touch Create Group. If necessary, specify a
login method to allow application access.
To delete a group, touch on top of the screen, touch Delete Groups, and then select the group.
To edit a contact group, touch GROUPS > select a group name > > select the action you want to make.
3 Apply the changes.
Set up, install, and configure 27
background
Setting up and using the accessibility features
Activating Voice Guidance
From the home screen
1
In one motion and using one finger, slowly swipe left then up on the display until you hear a voice message.
Note: For printer models without built-in speakers, use headphones to hear the message.
2 Using two fingers, touch OK.
Note: If the gesture does not work, then apply more pressure.
From the keyboard
1
Press and hold the 5 key until you hear a voice message.
Note: For printer models without built-in speakers, use headphones to hear the message.
2 Press Tab to navigate the focus cursor to the OK button, and then press Enter.
Notes:
When Voice Guidance is activated, always use two fingers to select any item on the display.
Voice Guidance has limited language support.
Deactivating Voice Guidance
1 In one motion and using one finger, slowly swipe left then up on the display until you hear a voice message.
Note: For printer models without built-in speakers, use headphones to hear the message.
2 Using two fingers, do either of the following:
Touch Voice Guidance, then touch OK.
Touch Cancel.
Note: If the gesture does not work, then apply more pressure.
You can also deactivate Voice Guidance by doing either of the following:
Using two
fingers,
double tap the home screen.
Press the power button to put the printer in Sleep or Hibernate mode.
Navigating the screen using gestures
Notes:
Most of the gestures are applicable only when Voice Guidance is activated.
Use a physical keyboard to type characters and adjust certain settings.
Set up, install, and configure 28
background
Gesture Function
Swipe left then up using one finger
Launch or exit Accessibility mode.
Note: This gesture is also applicable when the printer is in normal mode.
Doubletap using one finger
Select an option or item on the screen.
Doubletap the home icon using two
fingers
Deactivate the Accessibility mode.
Tripletap using one finger
Zoom in or zoom out text and images.
Note: Enable Magnification mode to use the zoom feature.
Set up, install, and configure 29
background
Gesture Function
Swipe right or swipe down using one
finger
Move to the next item on the screen.
Swipe left or swipe up using one
finger
Move to the previous item on the screen.
Set up, install, and configure 30
background
Gesture Function
Swipe up then down using one
finger
Move to the first item on the screen.
Pan
Access parts of the zoomed image that are beyond the limit of the screen.
Notes:
Use two fingers to drag a zoomed image.
Enable Magnification mode to use the pan gesture.
Swipe up then right using one finger
Increase the volume.
Note: This gesture is also applicable when the printer is in normal mode.
Swipe down then right using one
finger
Decrease the volume.
Note: This gesture is also applicable when the printer is in normal mode.
Set up, install, and configure 31
background
Gesture Function
Swipe up then left using one finger
Exit an application and return to the home screen.
Swipe down then left using one
finger
Go back to the previous setting.
Using the onscreen keyboard
When the onscreen keyboard appears, do one or more of the following:
Touch a key to announce and type the character in the field.
Drag a finger across dierent characters to announce and type the character in the field.
Touch a text box using two fingers to announce the characters in the field.
Touch Backspace to delete characters.
Enabling
Magnification
mode
1 In one motion and using one finger, slowly swipe left then up on the display until you hear a voice message.
Note: For printer models without built-in speakers, use headphones to hear the message.
2 Using two fingers, do the following:
a Touch
Magnification
mode.
b Tou ch OK.
Note: If the gesture does not work, then apply more pressure.
For more information on navigating a magnified screen, see
“Navigating the screen using gestures” on page
28.
Set up, install, and configure 32
background
Adjusting the Voice Guidance speech rate
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Accessibility > Speech Rate.
2 Select the speech rate.
Adjusting the default headphone volume
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Accessibility.
2 Adjust the headphone volume.
Note: The volume resets to the default value after the user exits Accessibility mode or when the printer
wakes from Sleep or Hibernate mode.
Adjusting the default internal speaker volume
1 From the home screen, touch .
2 Adjust the volume.
Notes:
If Quiet Mode is enabled, then audible alerts are turned o. This setting also slows the printer
performance.
The volume resets to the default value after the user exits Accessibility mode or when the printer wakes
from Sleep or Hibernate mode.
Enabling spoken passwords or personal identification numbers
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Accessibility > Speak Passwords/PINs.
2 Enable the setting.
Setting up the printer to fax
Supported fax
Printer model Analog fax
etherFAX
2
Fax server
3
Fax over IP (FoIP)
4
CX730
1
CX735
1
Needs an installed fax card to use analog fax.
2
Needs a subscription. For more information, go to https://www.etherfax.net/lexmark or contact the place where
you purchased the printer.
3
Needs a subscription for the fax server to work.
4
Needs an installed license bundle. For more information, contact the place where you purchased the printer.
Set up, install, and configure 33
background
Printer model Analog fax
etherFAX
2
Fax server
3
Fax over IP (FoIP)
4
XC4342
1
XC4352
1
Needs an installed fax card to use analog fax.
2
Needs a subscription. For more information, go to https://www.etherfax.net/lexmark or contact the place where
you purchased the printer.
3
Needs a subscription for the fax server to work.
4
Needs an installed license bundle. For more information, contact the place where you purchased the printer.
Setting up the fax function using analog fax
Notes:
For some printer models, a fax card must be installed for the printer to use analog fax.
Some connection methods are applicable only in some countries or regions.
If the fax function is enabled and not fully set up, then the indicator light may blink red.
If you do not have a TCP/IP environment, then use the control panel to set up fax.
Warning—Potential Damage: To avoid loss of data or printer malfunction, do not touch cables or the printer
in the area shown while actively sending or receiving a fax.
Using the Settings menu in the printer
1
From the home screen, touch Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > General Fax Settings.
2 Configure the settings.
Using the Embedded Web Server
1
Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Set up, install, and configure 34
background
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > General Fax Settings.
3
Configure
the settings.
4 Apply the changes.
Setting up the fax function using etherFAX
Notes:
The printer firmware must be updated to the latest version. For more information, see the “Updating
firmware” section.
An appropriate license bundle must be installed in your printer. For more information, contact etherFAX.
Make sure that you have registered your printer to the etherFAX portal. For more information, go to
https://www.etherfax.net/lexmark.
The printer serial number is required on registration. To locate the serial number, see “Finding the printer
serial number” on page 10.
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > General Fax Settings.
Note: Fax Setup appears only if Fax Mode is set to Fax.
3 In the Fax Name field, type a unique name.
4 In the Fax Number field, enter the fax number that etherFAX provided.
5 From the Fax Transport menu, select etherFAX.
Notes:
This menu shows up only when more than one fax transport is available.
If the printer only has etherFAX installed, then it is automatically configured.
6 Apply the changes.
Set up, install, and configure 35
background
Setting up the fax function using fax server
Notes:
This feature lets you send fax messages to a fax service provider that supports email receiving.
This feature supports outgoing fax messages only. To support fax receive, make sure that you have a
devicebased fax, such as analog fax, etherFAX, or Fax over IP (FoIP), configured in your printer.
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address
field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Fax.
3 From the Fax Mode menu, select Fax Server, and then click Save.
4 Click Fax Server Setup.
5 In the To Format field, type [#]@myfax.com, where [#] is the fax number and myfax.com is the fax
provider domain.
Notes:
If necessary,
configure
the Reply Address, Subject, or Message
fields.
To let the printer receive fax messages, enable the devicebased fax receive setting. Make sure that
you have a devicebased fax configured.
6 Click Save.
7 Click Fax Server Email Settings, and then do either of the following:
Enable Use Email SMTP Server.
Note: If the Email SMTP settings are not configured, then see “Configuring the email SMTP settings”
on page 40.
Configure the SMTP settings. For more information, contact your email service provider.
8 Apply the changes.
Setting up fax using a standard telephone line
Note: These instructions apply only to printers that support analog fax. For more information, see “Supported
fax” on page 33.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, do not set up this product or make
any electrical or cabling connections, such as the power cord, fax feature, or telephone, during a
lightning storm.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, do not use the fax feature during a
lightning storm.
Set up, install, and configure 36
background
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of fire, use only a 26 AWG or larger
telecommunications (RJ-11) cord when connecting this product to the public switched telephone
network. For users in Australia, the cord must be approved by the Australian Communications and Media
Authority.
Setup 1: Printer is connected to a dedicated fax line
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable to the line port of the printer.
2 Connect the other end of the cable to an active analog wall jack.
Notes:
You can set the printer to receive faxes automatically (set Auto Answer to On) or manually (set Auto
Answer to O).
If you want to receive faxes automatically, then set the printer to pick up on a specified number of rings.
Setup 2: Printer is sharing the line with an answering machine
Note: If you subscribe to a distinctive ring service, then make sure that you set the correct ring pattern for
the printer. Otherwise, the printer does not receive faxes even if you have set it to receive faxes
automatically.
Set up, install, and configure 37
background
Connected to dierent wall jacks
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable to the line port of the printer.
2 Connect the other end of the cable to an active analog wall jack.
Notes:
If you have only one telephone number on your line, then set the printer to receive faxes automatically.
Set the printer to pick up calls two rings after the answering machine. For example, if the answering
machine picks up calls after four rings, then set the printer Rings to Answer setting to 6.
Setting up fax in countries or regions with
dierent
telephone wall jacks
and plugs
Note: These instructions apply only to printers that support analog fax. For more information, see “Supported
fax” on page 33.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, do not set up this product or make
any electrical or cabling connections, such as the power cord, fax feature, or telephone, during a
lightning storm.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, do not use the fax feature during a
lightning storm.
Set up, install, and configure 38
background
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of fire, use only a 26 AWG or larger
telecommunications (RJ-11) cord when connecting this product to the public switched telephone
network. For users in Australia, the cord must be approved by the Australian Communications and Media
Authority.
The standard wall jack adopted by most countries or regions is RJ11. If the wall jack or equipment in your facility
is not compatible with this type of connection, then use a telephone adapter. An adapter for your country or
region may not come with your printer, and you may need to purchase it separately.
There may be an adapter plug installed in the telephone port of the printer. Do not remove the adapter plug
from the telephone port of the printer if you are connecting to a serial or cascaded telephone system.
Part name Part number
Lexmark adapter plug 40X8519
Connecting the printer to a nonRJ11 wall jack
Set up, install, and configure 39
background
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable to the line port of the printer.
2 Connect the other end of the cable to the RJ11 adapter, and then connect the adapter to the wall jack.
3 If you want to connect another device with a nonRJ11 connector to the same wall jack, then connect it
directly to the telephone adapter.
Connecting to a distinctive ring service
A distinctive ring service lets you have multiple telephone numbers on one telephone line. Each telephone
number is assigned a dierent ring pattern.
Note: These instructions apply only to printers that support analog fax. For more information, see
“Supported
fax” on page 33.
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > Fax Receive Settings > Admin Controls >
Answer On.
2 Select a ring pattern.
Setting the fax date and time
Note: Make sure that fax is configured. For more information, see the Setting up the printer to fax section.
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Preferences > Date and Time >
Configure
.
2 Configure the settings.
Configuring
daylight saving time
Note: Make sure that fax is configured. For more information, see the Setting up the printer to fax section.
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Preferences > Date and Time >
Configure
.
2 In the Time Zone menu, touch (UTC+user) Custom.
3 Touch UTC (GMT) Oset, and then configure the settings.
Configuring the fax speaker settings
Note: Make sure that fax is
configured.
For more information, see the Setting up the printer to fax section.
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > Speaker Settings.
2 Do the following:
Set Speaker Mode to Always On.
Set Speaker Volume to High.
Enable Ringer Volume.
Configuring the email SMTP settings
Configure
the Simple Mail Transfer Protocol (SMTP) settings to send a scanned document through e-mail. The
settings vary with each email service provider.
Set up, install, and configure 40
background
Before you begin, make sure that the printer is connected to a network and that the network is connected to
the Internet.
Using the Embedded Web Server
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Email.
3 From the Email Setup section, configure the settings.
Notes:
For more information, see the list of email service providers.
For email service providers that are not on the list, contact your provider and ask for the settings.
4 Click Save.
Using the Settings menu in the printer
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Email > Email Setup.
2 Configure the settings.
Notes:
For more information, see the list of email service providers.
For email service providers that are not on the list, contact your provider and ask for the settings.
Email service providers
AOL Mail
Comcast Mail
Gmail
iCloud Mail
Mail.com
NetEase Mail (mail.126.com)
NetEase Mail (mail.163.com)
NetEase Mail (mail.yeah.net)
Outlook Live or Microsoft 365
QQ Mail
Sina Mail
Sohu Mail
Yaho o ! Mai l
Zoho Mail
Set up, install, and configure 41
background
Notes:
If you encounter errors using the settings provided, then contact your email service provider.
For email service providers that are not on the list, contact your provider.
AOL Mail
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.aol.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certicate Disabled
Reply Address Your email address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
DeviceInitiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password App password
Note: To create an app password, go to the
AOL Account Security page, log
in to your account, and then click Generate app password.
Comcast Mail
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.comcast.net
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certicate Disabled
Reply Address Your email address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
DeviceInitiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Account password
Note: Make sure that the Third Party Access Security setting is enabled on your account. For more
information, go to the Comcast Xfinity Connect help page.
Set up, install, and configure 42
background
Gmail
TM
Note: Make sure that twostep
verification
is enabled on your Google account. To enable twostep
verification, go to the
Google Account Security page, log in to your account, and then from the “Signing in to
Google” section, click 2Step Verification.
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.gmail.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certicate Disabled
Reply Address Your email address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
DeviceInitiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password App password
Notes:
To create an app password, go to the Google Account Security page, log
in to your account, and then from the “Signing in to Google” section, click
App passwords.
App passwords” shows only if twostep verification is enabled.
iCloud Mail
Note: Make sure that twostep
verification
is enabled on your account.
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.mail.me.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certicate Disabled
Reply Address Your email address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
DeviceInitiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password App password
Note: To create an app password, go to the
iCloud Account Management
page, log in to your account, and then from the Security section, click
Generate Password.
Set up, install, and configure 43
background
Mail.com
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.mail.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certicate Disabled
Reply Address Your email address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
DeviceInitiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Account password
NetEase Mail (mail.126.com)
Note: Make sure that the SMTP service is enabled on your account. To enable the service, from the NetEase
Mail home page, click Settings > POP3/SMTP/IMAP, and then enable either IMAP/SMTP service or
POP3/SMTP service.
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.126.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 465
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certicate Disabled
Reply Address Your email address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
DeviceInitiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Authorization password
Note: The authorization password is provided when IMAP/SMTP service or
POP3/SMTP service is enabled.
NetEase Mail (mail.163.com)
Note: Make sure that the SMTP service is enabled on your account. To enable the service, from the NetEase
Mail home page, click Settings > POP3/SMTP/IMAP, and then enable either IMAP/SMTP service or
POP3/SMTP service.
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.163.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 465
Use SSL/TLS Required
Set up, install, and configure 44
background
Setting Value
Require Trusted Certicate Disabled
Reply Address Your email address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
DeviceInitiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Authorization password
Note: The authorization password is provided when IMAP/SMTP service or
POP3/SMTP service is enabled.
NetEase Mail (mail.yeah.net)
Note: Make sure that the SMTP service is enabled on your account. To enable the service, from the NetEase
Mail home page, click Settings > POP3/SMTP/IMAP, and then enable either IMAP/SMTP service or
POP3/SMTP service.
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.yeah.net
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 465
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certicate Disabled
Reply Address Your email address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
DeviceInitiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Authorization password
Note: The authorization password is provided when IMAP/SMTP service or
POP3/SMTP service is enabled.
Outlook Live or Microsoft 365
These settings apply to outlook.com and hotmail.com email domains, and Microsoft 365 accounts.
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.oce365.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certicate Disabled
Reply Address Your email address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
DeviceInitiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Set up, install, and configure 45
background
Setting Value
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Account password or app password
Notes:
For accounts with twostep verification disabled, use your account
password.
For outlook.com or hotmail.com accounts with twostep verification
enabled, use an app password. To create an app password, go to the
Outlook Live Account Management page, and then log in to your
account.
Note: For additional setup options for business using Microsoft 365, go to the Microsoft 365 help page.
QQ Mail
Note: Make sure that the SMTP service is enabled on your account. To enable the service, from the QQ Mail
home page, click Settings > Account. From the POP3/IMAP/SMTP/Exchange/CardDAV/CalDAV Service
section, enable either POP3/SMTP service or IMAP/SMTP service.
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.qq.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certicate Disabled
Reply Address Your email address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
DeviceInitiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Authorization code
Note: To generate an authorization code, from the QQ Mail home page, click
Settings > Account, and then from the
POP3/IMAP/SMTP/Exchange/CardDAV/CalDAV Service section, click
Generate authorization code.
Sina Mail
Note: Make sure that the POP3/SMTP service is enabled on your account. To enable the service, from the
Sina Mail home page, click Settings > More settings > Userend POP/IMAP/SMTP, and then enable
POP3/SMTP service.
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.sina.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Set up, install, and configure 46
background
Setting Value
Require Trusted Certicate Disabled
Reply Address Your email address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
DeviceInitiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Authorization code
Note: To create an authorization code, from the email home page, click
Settings > More settings > Userend POP/IMAP/SMTP, and then enable
Authorization code status.
Sohu Mail
Note: Make sure that the SMTP service is enabled on your account. To enable the service, from the Sohu
Mail home page, click Options > Settings > POP3/SMTP/IMAP, and then enable either IMAP/SMTP service
or POP3/SMTP service.
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.sohu.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 465
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certicate Disabled
Reply Address Your email address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
DeviceInitiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Independent password
Note: The independent password is provided when IMAP/SMTP service or
POP3/SMTP service is enabled.
Yahoo! Mail
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.mail.yahoo.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certicate Disabled
Reply Address Your email address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
DeviceInitiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Set up, install, and configure 47
background
Setting Value
Device Password App password
Note: To create an app password, go to the
Yahoo Account Security page,
log in to your account, and then click Generate app password.
Zoho Mail
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.zoho.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certicate Disabled
Reply Address Your email address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
DeviceInitiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Account password or app password
Notes:
For accounts with twostep verification disabled, use your account
password.
For accounts with twostep verification enabled, use an app password. To
create an app password, go to the
Zoho Mail Account Security page, log
in to your account, and then from the ApplicationSpecific Passwords
section, click Generate New Password.
Loading paper and specialty media
Setting the size and type of the specialty media
The trays automatically detect the size of plain paper. For specialty media like labels, card stock, or envelopes,
do the following:
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper > Tray Conguration > Paper Size/Type > select a paper
source.
2 Set the size and type of the specialty media.
Configuring
Universal paper settings
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper > Media
Configuration
> Universal Setup.
2 Configure the settings.
Set up, install, and configure 48
background
Enabling the Multiple Universal Sizes setting
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Maintenance >
Configuration
Menu > Tray
Configuration.
2 Enable the Multiple Universal Sizes setting.
Loading trays
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: To reduce the risk of equipment instability, load each tray separately.
Keep all other trays closed until needed.
1 Remove the tray.
Note: To avoid jams, do not remove trays while the printer is busy.
2 Adjust the guides to match the size of the paper that you are loading.
Note: Use the indicators on the bottom of the tray to position the guides.
Set up, install, and configure 49
background
3 Flex, fan, and align the paper edges before loading.
4 Load the paper stack with the printable side faceup.
For onesided printing, load letterhead faceup with the header toward the front of the tray.
For twosided printing, load letterhead facedown with the header toward the back of the tray.
Do not slide paper into the tray.
Set up, install, and configure 50
background
For plain paper, make sure that the stack height is below the maximum paper fill indicator. Overfilling
may cause paper jams.
For envelopes and other specialty media, make sure that the stack height is below the dashed line.
Overfilling may cause paper jams.
5 Insert the tray.
If necessary, set the paper size and type to match the paper loaded in the tray.
Set up, install, and configure 51
background
Loading the multipurpose feeder
1 Open the multipurpose feeder.
2 Adjust the guide to match the size of the paper that you are loading.
3 Flex, fan, and align the paper edges before loading.
Set up, install, and configure 52
background
4 Load the paper.
Load paper and card stock with the printable side facedown and the top edge entering the printer first.
Load envelope with the flap side up and against the right side of the paper guide. Load European
envelopes with the flap entering the printer first.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not use envelopes with stamps, clasps, snaps, windows, coated
linings, or selfstick adhesives.
Note: To avoid paper pick problems, make sure that the leading edge of the paper or specialty media is
properly aligned with the separator dam.
Set up, install, and configure 53
background
5 From the Paper menu in the control panel, set the paper size and type to match the paper loaded in the
multipurpose feeder.
Linking trays
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper > Tray
Configuration
> select a paper source.
2 Set the same paper size and paper type for the trays that you are linking.
3 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Maintenance >
Configuration
Menu > Tray
Configuration
> Tray Linking.
4 Touch Automatic.
To unlink trays, make sure that no trays have the same paper size and paper type settings.
Warning—Potential Damage: The temperature of the fuser varies according to the specified paper type. To
avoid printing issues, match the paper type setting in the printer with the paper loaded in the tray.
Installing and updating software, drivers, and firmware
Installing the printer software
Notes:
The print driver is included in the software installer package.
For Macintosh computers with macOS version 10.7 or later, you do not need to install the driver to print
on an AirPrint-certified printer. If you want custom printing features, then download the print driver.
1 Obtain a copy of the software installer package.
From the software CD that came with your printer.
Go to www.lexmark.com/downloads.
2 Run the installer, and then follow the instructions on the computer screen.
Set up, install, and configure 54
background
Installing the fax driver
1 Go to www.lexmark.com/downloads, search for your printer model, and then download the appropriate
installer package.
2 From your computer, click Printer Properties, and then navigate to the Configuration tab.
3 Select Fax, and then click Apply.
Adding printers to a computer
Before you begin, do one of the following:
Connect the printer and the computer to the same network. For more information on connecting the printer
to a network, see
“Connecting the printer to a WiFi network” on page 97.
Connect the computer to the printer. For more information, see “Connecting a computer to the printer” on
page 99.
Connect the printer to the computer using a USB cable. For more information, see Attaching cables” on
page 21.
Note: The USB cable is sold separately.
For Windows users
1
From a computer, install the print driver.
Note: For more information, see “Installing the printer software” on page 54.
2 Open Printers & scanners, and then click Add a printer or scanner.
3 Depending on your printer connection, do one of the following:
Select a printer from the list, and then click Add device.
Click Show WiFi Direct printers, select a printer, and then click Add device.
Click The printer that I want isn’t listed, and then from the Add Printer window, do the following:
a Select Add a printer using a TCP/IP address or hostname, and then click Next.
b In the “Hostname or IP address” field, type the printer IP address, and then click Next.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
c Select a print driver, and then click Next.
d Select Use the print driver that is currently installed (recommended), and then click Next.
e Type a printer name, and then click Next.
f Select a printer sharing option, and then click Next.
g Click Finish.
For Macintosh users
1
From a computer, open Printers & Scanners.
2 Click , and then select a printer.
3 From the Use menu, select a print driver.
Set up, install, and configure 55
background
Notes:
To use the Macintosh print driver, select either AirPrint or Secure AirPrint.
If you want custom printing features, then select the Lexmark print driver. To install the driver, see
“Installing the printer software” on page 54.
4 Add the printer.
Exporting or importing a configuration file
You can export the configuration settings of your printer into a text file, and then import the file to apply the
settings to other printers.
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 From the Embedded Web Server, click Export Configuration or Import Configuration.
3 Follow the instructions on the screen.
4 If the printer supports applications, then do the following:
a Click Apps > select the application >
Configure
.
b Click Export or Import.
Adding available options in the print driver
For Windows users
1 Open the printers folder.
2 Select the printer you want to update, and then do either of the following:
For Windows 7 or later, select Printer properties.
For earlier versions, select Properties.
3 Navigate to the Configuration tab, and then select Update Now Ask Printer.
4 Apply the changes.
For Macintosh users
1 From System Preferences in the Apple menu, navigate to your printer, and then select Options & Supplies.
2 Navigate to the list of hardware options, and then add any installed options.
3 Apply the changes.
Set up, install, and configure 56
background
Updating firmware
Updating the firmware using the control panel
Using the notification center
This method is applicable only in some printer models.
1 From the control panel, navigate to the notification center, and then select Firmware update available.
2 Select Install now.
The printer reboots automatically after the update.
Using the Settings menu
1 From the control panel, navigate to Settings > Device > Update Firmware.
2 Depending on your printer model, select Check for updates or Check for updates now.
3 If a new update is available, then select Install now.
The printer reboots automatically after the update.
Set up, install, and configure 57
background
Updating the firmware using the Embedded Web Server
Before you begin, make sure that:
You have downloaded the latest printer
firmware
from https://support.lexmark.com and saved it to your
flash drive or computer.
Note: To deploy the printer firmware, extract the .fls firmware file from the ZIP package.
You are not using a special code on your printer to avoid losing this functionality.
Warning—Potential Damage: Make sure that all printers receiving
firmware
updates are turned on during
the entire
firmware
update process. Turning
o
a printer during a
firmware
update can severely damage it.
If the printer is connected to the network when checking for updates, then downloading the firmware is not
required.
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Device.
3 Scroll down, and then click Update Firmware.
4 Depending on your printer model, click Check for updates or Check for updates now.
If a new update is available, then click I agree, start update.
The printer reboots automatically after the update.
Installing hardware options
Available internal options
Intelligent storage drive (ISD)
Fonts
Simplified Chinese
Traditional Chinese
Japanese
Korean
Arabic
Mass storage
Printer hard disk
Analog fax card
Licensed features
IPDS
Bar Code
Set up, install, and configure 58
background
Lexmark
TM
Internal solutions port
IEEE 1284B Parallel Card
RS232C Serial Card
Fiber Port
Wireless print server
MarkNet
TM
N8370
MarkNet N8372
MarkNet N8450
Notes:
An ISD or a hard disk is required to activate formsmerge and other features.
Some IPDS features require an ISD or a hard disk.
Installing optional trays
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, if you are accessing the controller
board or installing optional hardware or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn
the printer o, and unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any
other devices attached to the printer, then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the
printer.
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet, and then from the printer.
3 Unpack the optional tray, and then remove all the packing material.
Note: If optional trays are already installed, then unlock them from the printer before lifting the printer. Do
not try to lift the printer and trays at the same time.
4 Install the printer on top of the optional tray until it clicks into place.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: If the printer weight is greater than 20 kg (44 lb), then it may
require two or more people to lift it safely.
Set up, install, and configure 59
background
5 Connect the power cord to the printer, and then to the electrical outlet.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
6 Turn on the printer.
Add the tray in the print driver to make it available for print jobs. For more information, see
Adding available
options in the print driver” on page 56.
Installing the intelligent storage drive
When a hard disk and an intelligent storage drive are both installed, the printer always prioritizes the hard disk
to store user data.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, if you are accessing the controller
board or installing optional hardware or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn
the printer o, and unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any
other devices attached to the printer, then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the
printer.
1 Turn
o
the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
2 Using a flathead screwdriver, remove the controller board shield.
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static
electricity. Touch a metal surface on the printer before touching any controller board components or
connectors.
Set up, install, and configure 60
background
3 Unpack the intelligent storage drive (ISD).
Warning—Potential Damage: Avoid touching the connection points along the edge of the card.
Set up, install, and configure 61
background
4 Locate the ISD connector.
5 Insert the card to the ISD connector.
Set up, install, and configure 62
background
6 Attach the controller board shield.
7 Connect the power cord to the electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
Set up, install, and configure 63
background
Installing the Trusted Platform Module
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, if you are accessing the controller
board or installing optional hardware or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn
the printer o, and unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any
other devices attached to the printer, then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the
printer.
1 Turn o the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
2 Using a flathead screwdriver, remove the controller board shield.
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static
electricity. Touch a metal surface on the printer before touching any controller board components or
connectors.
Set up, install, and configure 64
background
3 Unpack the Trusted Platform Module.
Warning—Potential Damage: Avoid touching the connection points along the edge of the card.
4 Locate the TPM connector.
5 Attach the module to the TPM connector.
Set up, install, and configure 65
background
6 Attach the controller board shield.
7 Connect the power cord to the electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
Set up, install, and configure 66
background
Installing the fax card
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, if you are accessing the controller
board or installing optional hardware or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn
the printer o, and unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any
other devices attached to the printer, then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the
printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of fire, use only a 26 AWG or larger
telecommunications (RJ-11) cord when connecting this product to the public switched telephone
network. For users in Australia, the cord must be approved by the Australian Communications and Media
Authority.
1 Turn
o
the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
2 Using a flathead screwdriver, remove the controller board shield.
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static
electricity. Touch a metal surface on the printer before touching any controller board components or
connectors.
Set up, install, and configure 67
background
3 Remove the fax cover.
Set up, install, and configure 68
background
4 If a fax bracket is installed on your printer, then remove it.
5 Install the fax card to the bracket.
Notes:
If the fax card came with a bracket, then use that bracket.
If the fax card does not have a bracket, then use the bracket that you removed in step 4.
Set up, install, and configure 69
background
6 Install the fax card to the printer, and then connect the connector to the controller board.
Set up, install, and configure 70
background
7 Attach the controller board shield, and then install the screws.
8 Connect the power cord to the electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
Set up, install, and configure 71
background
Installing an internal solutions port
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, if you are accessing the controller
board or installing optional hardware or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn
the printer o, and unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any
other devices attached to the printer, then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the
printer.
1 Turn o the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
2 Using a flathead screwdriver, remove the controller board shield.
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static
electricity. Touch a metal surface on the printer before touching any controller board electronic
components or connectors.
Set up, install, and configure 72
background
3 Unpack the internal solutions port (ISP) kit.
1 ISP
2 Mounting bracket
3 Thumbscrews
4 Housing
5 ISP extended cable
Set up, install, and configure 73
background
4 Install the ISP into its housing.
Set up, install, and configure 74
background
5 Attach the housing to the controller board shield.
Set up, install, and configure 75
background
6 Connect the ISP extended cable to the ISP connector in the controller board.
Set up, install, and configure 76
background
7 Attach the controller board shield.
8 Connect the power cord to the electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
Changing the printer port settings after installing an internal solutions port
Notes:
If the printer has a static IP address, then do not change the configuration.
If the computers are configured to use the network name instead of an IP address, then do not change
the configuration.
If you are adding a wireless internal solutions port (ISP) to a printer previously configured for an Ethernet
connection, then disconnect the printer from the Ethernet network.
For Windows users
1
Open the printers folder.
2 From the shortcut menu of the printer with the new ISP, open the printer properties.
3 Configure the port from the list.
4 Update the IP address.
5 Apply the changes.
Set up, install, and configure 77
background
For Macintosh users
1
From System Preferences in the Apple menu, navigate to the list of printers, and then select + > IP.
2 Type the IP address in the address
field.
3 Apply the changes.
Installing a printer hard disk
When a hard disk and an intelligent storage drive are both installed, the printer always prioritizes the hard disk
to store user data.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, if you are accessing the controller
board or installing optional hardware or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn
the printer o, and unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any
other devices attached to the printer, then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the
printer.
1 Turn
o
the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
2 Using a flathead screwdriver, remove the controller board shield.
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static
electricity. Touch a metal surface on the printer before touching any controller board electronic
components or connectors.
Set up, install, and configure 78
background
3 Unpack the hard disk.
4 Attach the hard disk to the controller board.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch or press the center of the hard disk.
Set up, install, and configure 79
background
Set up, install, and configure 80
background
5 Attach the controller board shield.
6 Connect the power cord to the electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
Installing the convenience stapler
1 Turn o the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
2 Unpack the convenience stapler, and then remove all the packing material.
Set up, install, and configure 81
background
3 Connect the power supply to the convenience stapler.
Note: Use only the power supply that came with the convenience stapler. Using any other power supply
can damage the product.
Set up, install, and configure 82
background
4 Attach the cover of the power supply until it clicks into place.
Set up, install, and configure 83
background
5 Install the thumb screw into the cover of the power supply.
6 Remove the column cover above the standard bin.
Note: Make sure that the column cover is disposed properly.
Set up, install, and configure 84
background
7 Insert the power supply through the printer.
8 Install the convenience stapler.
Set up, install, and configure 85
background
9 Position the power supply properly.
10 Attach the stapler cover until it clicks into place.
Note: Make sure that the power supply is secured.
11 Connect the stapler and the printer power cords to the electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
Set up, install, and configure 86
background
Installing wireless modules
Installing MarkNet N8370 Wireless Print Server
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, if you are accessing the controller
board or installing optional hardware or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn
the printer o, and unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any
other devices attached to the printer, then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the
printer.
1 Turn o the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
2 Using a flathead screwdriver, remove the controller board shield.
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static
electricity. Touch a metal surface on the printer before touching any controller board electronic
components or connectors.
Set up, install, and configure 87
background
Set up, install, and configure 88
background
3 Install the wireless module into its housing.
Set up, install, and configure 89
background
4 Attach the wireless module to the controller board shield.
Set up, install, and configure 90
background
5 Connect the wireless assembly to the ISP connector in the controller board.
Set up, install, and configure 91
background
6 Attach the controller board shield.
Set up, install, and configure 92
background
7 Attach the NFC card.
8 Connect the power cord to the electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
Installing MarkNet N8372 Wireless Print Server
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Apply isopropyl alcohol to a damp, soft, lint-free cloth, and then wipe the surface around the USB port.
Set up, install, and configure 93
background
3 Install the wireless module.
Notes:
Apply firm pressure to make sure that the tape sticks to the surface of the printer.
Make sure that the printer surface is dry and free of condensed moisture.
The module is best bonded to the printer after 72 hours.
4 Check for a gap between the module and the printer, then attach the spacer module if necessary.
Set up, install, and configure 94
background
5 Attach the NFC card.
6 Turn on the printer.
Installing MarkNet N8450 Wireless Print Server
Note: Make sure that the printer is updated to the latest available
firmware.
1 Turn o the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
2 Depending on your printer model, locate the wireless print server port.
Set up, install, and configure 95
background
3 Insert the wireless print server until it clicks into place.
4 Depending on your printer model, close the door, attach the port cover, or do both.
5 Connect the power cord to the electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
Set up, install, and configure 96
background
Networking
Connecting the printer to a WiFi network
Before you begin, make sure that:
A wireless module is installed in your printer. For more information, see the Installing wireless modules
section.
Active Adapter is set to Auto. From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Network Overview
> Active Adapter.
Using the control panel
1
From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Wireless > Setup On Printer Panel > Choose
Network.
2 Select a WiFi network, and then type the network password.
Note: For printers that are WiFinetworkready, a prompt to set up the WiFi network appears during
initial setup.
Using Lexmark Mobile Assistant
1
Depending on your mobile device, download the Lexmark Mobile Assistant application from either the App
Store or Google Play
TM
.
2 From the printer home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Wireless > Setup Using Mobile App >
Printer ID.
3 From your mobile device, launch the application, and then accept the Terms of Use.
Note: If necessary, grant permissions.
4 Tap Connect to Printer > Go to WiFi Settings.
5 Connect your mobile device to the printer wireless network.
6 Return to the application, and then tap Setup Wi-Fi Connection
7 Select a Wi-Fi network, and then type the network password.
8 Tap Done.
Connecting the printer to a wireless network using WiFi Protected Setup
(WPS)
Before you begin, make sure that:
The access point (wireless router) is WPS
certified
or WPScompatible. For more information, see the
documentation that came with your access point.
A wireless module is installed in your printer. For more information, see the Installing wireless modules
section.
Active Adapter is set to Auto. From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Network Overview
> Active Adapter.
Set up, install, and configure 97
background
Using the Push-Button method
1
From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Wireless > WiFi Protected Setup > Start Push
Button Method.
2 Follow the instructions on the display.
Using the personal
identification
number (PIN) method
1
From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Wireless > WiFi Protected Setup > Start PIN
Method.
2 Copy the eightdigit WPS PIN.
3 Open a web browser, and then type the IP address of your access point in the address
field.
Notes:
To know the IP address, see the documentation that came with your access point.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
4 Access the WPS settings. For more information, see the documentation that came with your access point.
5 Enter the eightdigit PIN, and then save the changes.
Configuring
WiFi Direct
Wi-Fi Direct
®
allows wireless devices to connect directly to a Wi-Fi Directenabled printer without using an
access point (wireless router).
Before you begin, make sure that a wireless module is installed on your printer. For more information, see the
Installing wireless modules section.
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Wi-Fi Direct.
2
Configure
the settings.
Enable WiFi Direct—Enables the printer to broadcast its own WiFi Direct network.
WiFi Direct Name—Assigns a name for the WiFi Direct network.
WiFi Direct Password—Assigns the password for negotiating the wireless security when using the
peerto-peer connection.
Show Password on Setup Page—Shows the password on the Network Setup Page.
Auto-Accept Push Button Requests—Lets the printer accept connection requests automatically.
Note: Accepting pushbutton requests automatically is not secured.
Notes:
By default, the Wi-Fi Direct network password is not visible on the printer display. To show the password,
enable the password peek icon. From the home screen, touch Settings > Security > Miscellaneous >
Enable Password/PIN Reveal.
You can see the password of the Wi-Fi Direct network without showing it on the printer display. From the
home screen, touch Settings > Reports > Network > Network Setup Page.
Set up, install, and configure 98
background
Connecting a mobile device to the printer
Before connecting your mobile device, make sure that WiFi Direct has been configured. For more information,
see
“Configuring WiFi Direct” on page 98.
Connecting using WiFi Direct
Note: These instructions apply only to Android mobile devices.
1 From the mobile device, go to the settings menu.
2 Enable WiFi, and then tap WiFi Direct.
3 Select the printer Wi-Fi Direct name.
4
Confirm
the connection on the printer control panel.
Connecting using WiFi
1
From the mobile device, go to the settings menu.
2 Tap WiFi, and then select the printer Wi-Fi Direct name.
Note: The string DIRECT-xy (where x and y are two random characters) is added before the Wi-Fi Direct
name.
3 Enter the Wi-Fi Direct password.
Connecting a computer to the printer
Before connecting your computer, make sure that WiFi Direct has been configured. For more information, see
“Configuring WiFi Direct” on page 98.
For Windows users
1
Open Printers & scanners, and then click Add a printer or scanner.
2 Click Show Wi-Fi Direct printers, and then select the printer WiFi Direct name.
3 From the printer display, take note of the eight-digit PIN of the printer.
4 Enter the PIN on the computer.
Note: If the print driver is not already installed, then Windows downloads the appropriate driver.
For Macintosh users
1
Click the wireless icon, and then select the printer WiFi Direct name.
Note: The string DIRECT-xy (where x and y are two random characters) is added before the Wi-Fi Direct
name.
2 Type the WiFi Direct password.
Note: Switch your computer back to its previous network after disconnecting from the Wi-Fi Direct network.
Set up, install, and configure 99
background
Deactivating the WiFi network
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Network Overview > Active Adapter > Standard
Network.
2 Follow the instructions on the display.
Checking the printer connectivity
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Reports > Network > Network Setup Page.
2 Check the first section of the network setup page, and confirm that the status is connected.
If the status is not connected, then the LAN drop may be inactive, or the network cable may be
malfunctioning. Contact your administrator for assistance.
Setting up serial printing (Windows only)
Before you begin, make sure that a serial internal solutions port is installed in your printer.
1 Set the parameters in the printer.
a From the control panel, navigate to the menu for the port settings.
b Locate the menu for the serial port settings, and then adjust the settings, if necessary.
c Apply the changes.
2 From your computer, open the printers folder, and then select your printer.
3 Open the printer properties, and then select the COM port from the list.
4 Set the COM port parameters in Device Manager.
Notes:
Serial printing reduces printing speed.
Make sure that the serial cable is connected to the serial port on your printer.
Set up, install, and configure 100
background
Secure the printer
Locating the security slot
The printer is equipped with a security lock feature. Attach a security lock compatible with most laptop
computers in the location shown to secure the printer in place.
Erasing printer memory
To erase volatile memory or buered data in your printer, turn o the printer.
To erase nonvolatile memory, device and network settings, security settings, and embedded solutions, do the
following:
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Maintenance > Out of Service Erase.
2 Touch t h e Sanitize all information on nonvolatile memory check box, and then touch ERASE.
3 Touch Start initial setup wizard or Leave printer
oine
, and then touch Next.
4 Start the operation.
Note: This process destroys the encryption key that is used to protect user data. Format the hard disk and
intelligent storage drive after erasing the printer memory.
Erasing printer storage drive
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Maintenance > Out of Service Erase.
2 Depending on the storage drive that is installed on your printer, do either of the following:
For hard disk, touch the Sanitize all information on hard disk check box, touch ERASE, and then select
a method to erase data.
Note: The process to sanitize the hard disk can take from several minutes to more than an hour,
making the printer unavailable for other tasks.
For intelligent storage drive (ISD), touch Erase Intelligent Storage Drive, and then touch ERASE to erase
all user data.
3 Start the operation.
Secure the printer 101
background
Restoring factory default settings
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Restore Factory Defaults.
2 To uc h Restore Settings > select the settings that you want to restore > RESTORE.
3 Start the operation.
Statement of Volatility
Type of memory Description
Volatile memory The printer uses standard random access memory (RAM)
to buer temporarily user data during simple print and
copy jobs.
Nonvolatile memory The printer may use two forms of non-volatile memory:
EEPROM and NAND (flash memory). Both types store the
operating system, printer settings, and network
information. They also store scanner and bookmark
settings and embedded solutions.
Hard disk storage drive Some printers may have a hard disk drive installed. The
printer hard disk is designed for printer-specific
functionality. The hard disk lets the printer retain buered
user data from complex print jobs, form data, and font
data.
Intelligent storage drive (ISD) Some printers may have an ISD installed. ISD uses non-
volatile flash memory to store user data from complex
print jobs, form data, and font data.
Erase the content of any installed printer memory in the following circumstances:
The printer is decommissioned.
The printer hard disk or ISD is replaced.
The printer is moved to a dierent department or location.
The printer is serviced by someone from outside your organization.
The printer is removed from your premises for service.
The printer is sold to another organization.
Note: To dispose a storage drive, follow the policies and procedures of your organization.
Secure the printer 102
background
Print
Printing from a computer
Note: For labels, card stock, and envelopes, set the paper size and type in the printer before printing the
document.
1 From the document that you are trying to print, open the Print dialog.
2 If necessary, adjust the settings.
3 Print the document.
Printing from a mobile device
Printing from a mobile device using Lexmark Mobile Print
Printing from a mobile device using Lexmark Mobile Print
Lexmark Mobile Print allows you to send documents and images directly to a supported Lexmark printer.
1 Open the document, and then send or share the document to Lexmark Mobile Print.
Note: Some thirdparty applications may not support the send or share feature. For more information, see
the documentation that came with the application.
2 Select a printer.
3 Print the document.
Printing from a mobile device using Lexmark Print
Lexmark Print is a mobile printing solution for mobile devices running on Android
TM
version 6.0 or later. It lets
you send documents and images to network-connected printers and print management servers.
Notes:
Make sure that you download the Lexmark Print application from the Google Play store and enable it in
the mobile device.
Make sure that the printer and the mobile device are connected to the same network.
1 From your mobile device, select a document from the
file
manager.
2 Send or share the document to Lexmark Print.
Note: Some thirdparty applications may not support the send or share feature. For more information, see
the documentation that came with the application.
3 Select a printer, and then adjust the settings, if necessary.
4 Print the document.
Print 103
background
Printing from a mobile device using Mopria Print Service
Mopria
®
Print Service is a mobile printing solution for mobile devices running on Android version 5.0 or later. It
allows you to print directly to any Mopriacertified printer.
Note: Make sure that you download the Mopria Print Service application from the Google Play store and
enable it in the mobile device.
1 From your Android mobile device, launch a compatible application or select a document from your file
manager.
2 Tap > Print.
3 Select a printer, and then adjust the settings, if necessary.
4 Tap .
Printing from a mobile device using AirPrint
The AirPrint software feature is a mobile printing solution that allows you to print directly from Apple devices
to an AirPrintcertified printer.
Notes:
Make sure that the Apple device and the printer are connected to the same network. If the network has
multiple wireless hubs, then make sure that both devices are connected to the same subnet.
This application is supported only in some Apple devices.
1 From your mobile device, select a document from your
file
manager or launch a compatible application.
2 Tap > Print.
3 Select a printer, and then adjust the settings, if necessary.
4 Print the document.
Printing from a mobile device using WiFi Direct®
WiFi Direct
®
is a printing service that lets you print to any WiFi Directready printer.
Note: Make sure that the mobile device is connected to the printer wireless network. For more information,
see
“Connecting a mobile device to the printer” on page 99.
1 From your mobile device, launch a compatible application or select a document from your file manager.
2 Depending on your mobile device, do one of the following:
Tap > Print.
Tap > Print.
Tap > Print.
3 Select a printer, and then adjust the settings, if necessary.
4 Print the document.
Print 104
background
Printing from a flash drive
1 Insert the flash drive.
Notes:
If you insert the flash drive when an error message appears, then the printer ignores the flash drive.
If you insert the flash drive while the printer is processing other print jobs, then Busy appears on the
display.
2 From the display, touch the document that you want to print.
If necessary, configure the print settings.
3 Print the document.
To print another document, touch USB Drive.
Warning—Potential Damage: To avoid loss of data or printer malfunction, do not touch the
flash
drive or
the printer in the area shown while actively printing, reading, or writing from the memory device.
Print 105
background
Supported flash drives and file types
Flash drives
Lexar JumpDrive S70 (16GB and 32GB)
SanDisk Cruzer Micro (16GB and 32GB)
PNY Attaché (16GB and 32GB)
Notes:
The printer supports highspeed flash drives with fullspeed standard.
Flash drives must support the File Allocation Table (FAT) system.
File types
Documents Images
PDF (version 1.7 or earlier)
Microsoft file formats (DOC, DOCX, XLS, XLSX, PPT, PPTX)
JPEG or JPG
TIFF or TIF
GIF
BMP
PNG
PCX
DCX
Configuring confidential jobs
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Security > Confidential Print Setup.
2 Configure the settings.
Print 106
background
Setting Description
Max Invalid PIN Set the limit for entering an invalid PIN.
Note: When the limit is reached, the print jobs for that user name are deleted.
Confidential Job
Expiration
Set an individual expiration time for each held job before it is automatically deleted from
the printer memory, hard disk, or intelligent storage drive.
Note: A held job is either
Confidential,
Repeat, Reserve, or Verify.
Repeat Job Expiration Set the expiration time for print jobs that you want to repeat.
Verify Job Expiration Set the expiration time for printing a copy of a job for you to check its quality before
printing the remaining copies.
Reserve Job Expiration Set the expiration time for jobs that you want to store in the printer for printing later.
Require All Jobs to be
Held
Set the printer to hold all print jobs.
Keep duplicate
documents
Set the printer to keep all documents with the same file name.
Printing confidential and other held jobs
For Windows users
1 With a document open, click File > Print.
2 Select a printer, and then click Properties, Preferences, Options, or Setup.
3 Click Print and Hold.
4 Select Use Print and Hold, and then assign a user name.
5 Select the print job type (Confidential, Repeat, Reserve, or Verify).
If you select Confidential, then secure the print job with a personal identification number (PIN).
6 Click OK or Print.
7 From the printer home screen, release the print job.
For confidential print jobs, touch Held jobs > select your user name > Confidential > enter the PIN >
select the print job > configure the settings > Print.
For other print jobs, touch Held jobs > select your user name > select the print job >
configure
the settings
> Print.
For Macintosh users
Using AirPrint
1 With a document open, choose File > Print.
2 Select a printer, and then from the drop-down menu following the Orientation menu, choose PIN Printing.
3 Enable Print with PIN, and then enter a fourdigit PIN.
Print 107
background
4 Click Print.
5 From the printer home screen, release the print job. Touch Held jobs > select your computer name >
Confidential > enter the PIN > select the print job > Print.
Using the print driver
1 With a document open, choose File > Print.
2 Select a printer, and then from the drop-down menu following the Orientation menu, choose Print and Hold.
3 Choose Confidential Print, and then enter a fourdigit PIN.
4 Click Print.
5 From the printer home screen, release the print job. Touch Held jobs > select your computer name >
Confidential
> select the print job > enter the PIN > Print.
Printing a font sample list
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Reports > Print > Print Fonts.
2 To uc h PCL Fonts or PS Fonts.
Printing a directory list
From the home screen, touch Settings > Reports > Print > Print Directory.
Placing separator sheets between copies
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Layout > Separator Sheets > Between Copies.
2 Print the document.
Canceling a print job
1 From the home screen, touch .
2 Select the job to cancel.
Note: You can also cancel a job by touching Job Queue.
Adjusting toner darkness
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality.
2 In the Toner Darkness menu, adjust the settings.
Print 108
background
Copy
Using the automatic document feeder and scanner glass
Automatic document feeder (ADF) Scanner glass
Use the ADF for multiplepage or two-sided
documents.
Load an original document faceup. For multiplepage
documents, make sure to align the leading edge
before loading.
Make sure to adjust the ADF guides to match the width
of the paper that you are loading.
Use the scanner glass for singlepage documents,
book pages, small items (such as postcards or
photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media
(such as magazine clippings).
Place the document facedown in the corner with the
arrow.
Making copies
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
Note: To avoid a cropped image, make sure that the original document and output have the same paper
size.
2 From the home screen, touch Copy, and then specify the number of copies.
If necessary, adjust the copy settings.
3 Copy the document.
Note: To make a quick copy, from the home screen, touch
.
Copying photos
1 Place a photo on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Copy > Content > Content Type > Photo.
3 Touch Content Source, and then select the setting that best matches the original photo.
4 Copy the photo.
Copy 109
background
Copying on letterhead
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Copy > Copy From > select the size of the original document.
3 Touch Copy To, and then select the paper source that contains the letterhead.
If you loaded the letterhead into the multipurpose feeder, then touch Copy To > Multipurpose Feeder >
select a paper size > Letterhead.
4 Copy the document.
Copying on both sides of the paper
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Copy > Sides.
3 Touch 1 sided to 2 sided or 2 sided to 2 sided.
4 Copy the document.
Reducing or enlarging copies
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Copy > Scale > select a scale value.
Note: Changing the size of the original document or output after setting Scale restores the scale value to
Auto.
3 Copy the document.
Collating copies
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Copy > Collate > On [1,2,1,2,1,2].
3 Copy the document.
Placing separator sheets between copies
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Copy > Separator Sheets.
3 Adjust the settings.
4 Send the copy job.
Copy 110
background
Copying multiple pages onto a single sheet
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Copy > Pages per Side.
3 Adjust the settings.
4 Copy the document.
Copying cards
1 Load a card on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Copy > Copy From.
3 Touch ID Card.
4 Copy the card.
Creating a copy shortcut
1 From the home screen, touch Copy.
2
Configure
the settings, and then touch
.
3 Create a shortcut.
Copy 111
background
E-mail
Using the automatic document feeder and scanner glass
Automatic document feeder (ADF) Scanner glass
Use the ADF for multiplepage or two-sided
documents.
Load an original document faceup. For multiplepage
documents, make sure to align the leading edge
before loading.
Make sure to adjust the ADF guides to match the width
of the paper that you are loading.
Use the scanner glass for singlepage documents,
book pages, small items (such as postcards or
photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media
(such as magazine clippings).
Place the document facedown in the corner with the
arrow.
Sending an e-mail
Before you begin, make sure that the SMTP settings are configured. For more information, see “Configuring
the email SMTP settings” on page 40.
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch E-mail, and then enter the needed information.
3 If necessary,
configure
the scan settings.
4 Send the e-mail.
Creating an e-mail shortcut
1 From the home screen, touch Email.
2 Configure the settings, and then touch .
3 Create a shortcut.
E-mail 112
background
Fax
Using the automatic document feeder and scanner glass
Automatic document feeder (ADF) Scanner glass
Use the ADF for multiplepage or two-sided
documents.
Load an original document faceup. For multiplepage
documents, make sure to align the leading edge
before loading.
Make sure to adjust the ADF guides to match the width
of the paper that you are loading.
Use the scanner glass for singlepage documents,
book pages, small items (such as postcards or
photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media
(such as magazine clippings).
Place the document facedown in the corner with the
arrow.
Sending a fax
Note: Make sure that fax is
configured.
For more information, see the Setting up the printer to fax section.
Using the control panel
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Fax, and then enter the needed information.
If necessary, adjust the settings.
3 Send the fax.
Using the computer
Before you begin, make sure that the fax driver is installed. For more information, see “Installing the fax driver”
on page 55.
For Windows users
1
From the document that you are trying to fax, open the Print dialog.
2 Select the printer, and then click Properties, Preferences, Options, or Setup.
3 Click Fax > Enable fax > Always display settings prior to faxing, and then enter the recipient number.
If necessary, configure other fax settings.
4 Send the fax.
Fax 113
background
For Macintosh users
1
With a document open, choose File > Print.
2 Select the printer that has Fax added after its name.
3 In the To
field,
enter the recipient number.
If necessary, configure other fax settings.
4 Send the fax.
Scheduling a fax
Note: Make sure that fax is configured. For more information, see the Setting up the printer to fax section.
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Fax > To > enter the fax number > Done.
3 Touch Send Time, configure the date and time, and then touch OK.
4 Send the fax.
Creating a fax destination shortcut
Note: Make sure that fax is
configured.
For more information, see the Setting up the printer to fax section.
1 From the home screen, touch Fax > To.
2 Enter the recipient number, and then touch Done.
3
Configure
the settings, and then touch
.
4 Create a shortcut.
Changing the fax resolution
Note: Make sure that fax is configured. For more information, see the Setting up the printer to fax section.
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Fax, and then enter the needed information.
3 Touch Resolution, and then select a setting.
4 Send the fax.
Adjusting the fax darkness
Note: Make sure that fax is
configured.
For more information, see the Setting up the printer to fax section.
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Fax, and then enter the needed information.
Fax 114
background
3 Touch Darkness, and then adjust the setting.
4 Send the fax.
Printing a fax log
Note: Make sure that analog fax or etherFAX is
configured.
For more information, see the Setting up the
printer to fax section.
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Reports > Fax.
2 To uc h Fax Job Log or Fax Call Log.
Blocking junk faxes
Note: Make sure that analog fax or etherFAX is configured. For more information, see the Setting up the
printer to fax section.
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > Fax Receive Settings > Admin Controls.
2 Set Block No Name Fax to On.
Holding faxes
Note: Make sure that analog fax or etherFAX is configured. For more information, see the Setting up the
printer to fax section.
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > Fax Receive Settings > Holding Faxes.
2 Select a mode.
Forwarding a fax
Note: Make sure that analog fax or etherFAX is configured. For more information, see the Setting up the
printer to fax section.
1 Create a destination shortcut.
a Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
b Click Shortcuts > Add Shortcut.
c Select a shortcut type, and then configure the settings.
Note: Take note of the shortcut number.
d Apply the changes.
2 Click Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > Fax Receive Settings > Admin Controls.
Fax 115
background
3 In the Fax Forwarding menu, select Forward or Print and Forward.
4 In the Forward to menu, select the destination type and then type the shortcut number.
5 Apply the changes.
Fax 116
background
Scan
Using the automatic document feeder and scanner glass
Automatic document feeder (ADF) Scanner glass
Use the ADF for multiplepage or two-sided
documents.
Load an original document faceup. For multiplepage
documents, make sure to align the leading edge
before loading.
Make sure to adjust the ADF guides to match the width
of the paper that you are loading.
Use the scanner glass for singlepage documents,
book pages, small items (such as postcards or
photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media
(such as magazine clippings).
Place the document facedown in the corner with the
arrow.
Scanning to a computer
Before you begin, make sure that the computer and the printer are connected to the same network.
For Windows users
Using Lexmark ScanBack Utility
1 From the computer, run Lexmark ScanBack Utility, and then click Next.
Note: To download the utility, go to www.lexmark.com/downloads.
2 Click Setup, and then add the printer IP address.
Note: View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
3 Click Close > Next.
4 Select the size of the original document, and then click Next.
5 Select a file format and scan resolution, and then click Next.
6 Type a unique scan profile name, and then click Next.
7 Browse to the location you want to save the scanned document, create a file name, and then click Next.
Note: To reus e t he scan
profile,
enable Create Shortcut, and then create a unique shortcut name.
8 Click Finish.
Scan 117
background
9 Load an original document into the automatic document feeder or on the scanner glass.
10 From the printer home screen, touch Scan Profiles > Scan to Computer, and then select a scan profile.
Using Windows Fax and Scan
Note: Make sure that the printer is added to the computer. For more information, see
Adding printers to a
computer” on page 55.
1 Load an original document into the automatic document feeder or on the scanner glass.
2 From the computer, open Windows Fax and Scan.
3 From the Source menu, select a scanner source.
4 If necessary, change the scan settings.
5 Scan the document.
For Macintosh users
Note: Make sure that the printer is added to the computer. For more information, see Adding printers to a
computer” on page 55.
1 Load an original document into the automatic document feeder or on the scanner glass.
2 From the computer, do either of the following:
Open Image Capture.
Open Printers & Scanners, and then select a printer. Click Scan > Open Scanner.
3 From the Scanner window, do one or more of the following:
Select where you want to save the scanned document.
Select the size of the original document.
To scan from the ADF, select Document Feeder from the Scan Menu or enable Use Document Feeder.
If necessary, configure the scan settings.
4 Click Scan.
Scanning to an FTP server
1 Load the original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch FTP, and then enter the needed information.
3 If necessary, configure other FTP settings.
4 Send the FTP job.
Creating an FTP shortcut
1 From the home screen, touch FTP.
2 Enter the FTP server address, and then touch .
3 Create a shortcut.
Scan 118
background
Scanning to a network folder
1 Load the document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Scan Center.
Note: The icon and name may have been changed. For more information, contact your administrator.
3 Do either of the following:
Select a destination.
Note: For SFTP, set the port number to 22.
Use a shortcut by touching , and then selecting the shortcut from the list.
4 Scan the document.
Creating a network folder shortcut
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Shortcuts > Add Shortcut.
3 From the Shortcut Type menu, select Network Folder, and then
configure
the settings.
4 Apply the changes.
Scan 119
background
Scanning to a flash drive
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 Insert the flash drive.
3 Touch Scan to USB and adjust the settings if necessary.
Notes:
To save the scanned document to a folder, touch Scan to, select a folder, and then touch Scan Here.
If the USB Drive screen does not appear, then touch USB Drive on the control panel.
4 Scan the document.
Warning—Potential Damage: To avoid loss of data or printer malfunction, do not touch the
flash
drive or
the printer in the area shown while actively printing, reading, or writing from the memory device.
Scan 120
background
Use printer menus
Menu map
Device
Preferences
EcoMode
Remote Operator Panel
Notifications
Power Management
Anonymous Data Collection
Accessibility
Restore Factory Defaults
Maintenance
Home Screen Customization
Update firmware
About this Printer
Print
Layout
Setup
Quality
Job Accounting
PDF
PostScript
PCL
Image
Paper
Tray Configuration Media Configuration
Copy
Copy Defaults
Fax
Fax Defaults
Email
Email Setup
Email Defaults
Web Link Setup
FTP
FTP Defaults
USB Drive
Flash Drive Scan Flash Drive Print
Network/Ports
Network Overview
Wireless
WiFi Direct
Mobile Services Management
Ethernet
TCP/IP
SNMP
IPSec
802.1x
LPD Configuration
HTTP/FTP Settings
ThinPrint
USB
Restrict external network access
Security
Login Methods
Schedule USB Devices
Security Audit Log
Login Restrictions
Confidential Print Setup
Disk Encryption
Erase Temporary Data Files
Solutions LDAP Settings
Miscellaneous
Cloud Services
Cloud Services Enrollment
Reports
Menu Settings Page
Device
Print
Shortcuts
Fax
Network
Troubleshooting Print Quality Test Pages Cleaning the Scanner
Use printer menus 121
background
Device
Preferences
Menu item Description
Display Language
[List of languages]
Set the language of the text that appears on the display.
Country/Region
[List of countries or regions]
Identify the country or region where the printer is configured
to operate.
Run initial setup
O*
On
Run the setup wizard.
Keyboard
Keyboard Type
[List of languages]
Select a language as a keyboard type.
Note: All the Keyboard Type values may not appear or may
require special hardware to appear.
Displayed information
Display Text 1 (IP Address*)
Display Text 2 (Date/Time*)
Custom Text 1
Custom Text 2
Specify the information to appear on the home screen.
Date and Time
Configure
Current Date and Time
Manually Set Date and Time
Date Format (MMDDYYYY*)
Time Format (12 hour A.M./P.M.*)
Time Zone (UTC5:00*)
Network Time Protocol
Enable NTP (On*)
NTP Server
Enable Authentication (None*)
Configure the printer date and time and network time protocol.
Paper Sizes
U.S.*
Metric
Specify the unit of measurement for paper sizes.
Note: The country or region selected in the initial setup
wizard determines the initial paper size setting.
Screen Brightness
20–100% (100*)
Adjust the brightness of the display.
Flash Drive Access
Disabled
Enabled*
Enable access to the flash drive.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 122
background
Menu item Description
Allow Background Removal
O
On*
Specify whether background removal is allowed.
Allow Custom Job scans
O
On*
Specify whether the Custom Job Scanning setting appears for
copy, scan, and fax.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an
intelligent storage drive is installed.
One Page Flatbed Scanning
O*
On
Set the printer to scan any type of job involving the scanner
glass as a single page.
Note: The printer returns to the home screen after
performing a single flatbed scan instead of displaying
prompts.
Device Sounds
Mute All Sounds (O*)
Button Feedback (On*)
Volume (5*)
ADF Loaded Beep (On*)
Alarm Control (Single*)
Cartridge Alarm (Single*)
Speaker Mode (Always O*)
Ringer Volume
(O*)
Configure the sound settings of the printer.
Screen Timeout
5–300 seconds (60*)
Set the idle time in seconds before the display shows the home
screen, or before the printer logs out a user account
automatically.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Eco-Mode
Menu item Description
Print
Sides
1Sided*
2Sided
Specify whether to print on one side or both sides of the paper.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 123
background
Menu item Description
Print
Pages per Side
O*
2 pages per side
3 pages per side
4 pages per side
6 pages per side
9 pages per side
12 pages per side
16 pages per side
Print multiple page images on one side of a sheet of paper.
Print
Toner Darkness
1–5 (4*)
Determine the lightness or darkness of text images.
Print
Color Saver
O*
On
Reduce the amount of toner used to print graphics and images.
Copy
Sides
1 sided to 1 sided*
1 sided to 2 sided
2 sided to 1 sided
2 sided to 2 sided
Specify the scanning behavior based on the original
document.
Copy
Pages per Side
O*
2 Portrait pages
4 Portrait pages
2 Landscape pages
4 Landscape pages
Specify the scanning behavior based on the original
document.
Copy
Darkness
1–9 (5*)
Determine the darkness of the scanned text images.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Remote Operator Panel
Menu item Description
External VNC Connection
Don’t Allow*
Allow
Connect an external Virtual Network Computing (VNC) client
to the remote control panel.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 124
background
Menu item Description
Authentication Type
None*
Standard Authentication
Set the authentication type when accessing the VNC client
server.
VNC Password Specify the password to connect to the VNC client server.
Note: This menu item appears only if Authentication Type is
set to Standard Authentication.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Notifications
Menu item Description
ADF Loaded Beep
O
On*
Enable a sound when loading paper into the ADF.
Alarm Control
O
Single*
Continuous
Set the number of times that the alarm sounds when the printer
requires user intervention.
Supplies
Show Supply Estimates
Show estimates*
Do not show estimates
Show the estimated status of the supplies.
Supplies
Cartridge Alarm
O
Single*
Continuous
Set the number of times that the alarm sounds when the
cartridge is low.
Supplies
Custom Supply Notifications
Configure notification settings when the printer requires user
intervention.
Note: This menu item appears only in the Embedded Web
Server.
Email Alerts Setup
Email Setup
Primary SMTP Gateway
Type the IP address or host name of the primary SMTP server
for sending e-mail.
Email Alerts Setup
Email Setup
Primary SMTP Gateway Port (25*)
Enter the port number of the primary SMTP server.
Email Alerts Setup
Email Setup
Secondary SMTP Gateway
Type the server IP address or host name of your secondary or
backup SMTP server.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 125
background
Menu item Description
Email Alerts Setup
Email Setup
Secondary SMTP Gateway Port (25*)
Enter the server port number of your secondary or backup
SMTP server.
Email Alerts Setup
Email Setup
SMTP Timeout (30*)
Specify how long before the printer times out if the SMTP
server does not respond.
Email Alerts Setup
Email Setup
Reply Address
Specify a reply address in the email.
Email Alerts Setup
Email Setup
Always use SMTP default Reply Address
(O*)
Use the SMTP default Reply Address.
Email Alerts Setup
Email Setup
Use SSL/TLS (Disabled*)
Send an email using an encrypted link.
Email Alerts Setup
Email Setup
Require Trusted
Certificate
(On*)
Require a trusted certificate when accessing the SMTP server.
Email Alerts Setup
Email Setup
SMTP Server Authentication (No
authentication required*)
Set the authentication type for the SMTP server.
Email Alerts Setup
Email Setup
DeviceInitiated Email (None*)
Set whether credentials are required for deviceinitiated
emails.
Email Alerts Setup
Email Setup
UserInitiated Email (None*)
Set whether credentials are required for user
initiated emails.
Email Alerts Setup
Email Setup
Use Active Directory Device Credentials
(O*)
Enable user credentials and group designations to connect to
the SMTP server.
Email Alerts Setup
Email Setup
Device Userid
Specify the user ID to connect to the SMTP server.
Email Alerts Setup
Email Setup
Device Password
Specify the password to connect to the SMTP server.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 126
background
Menu item Description
Email Alerts Setup
Email Setup
Kerberos 5 REALM
Specify the realm for the Kerberos 5 authentication protocol.
Email Alerts Setup
Email Setup
NTLM Domain
Specify the domain name for the NTLM security protocol.
Email Alerts Setup
Email Setup
Disable “SMTP server not set up” error (O*)
Disable an SMTP setup error message to appear on the
display.
Error Prevention
ADF Multifeed Sensor
O
On*
Detect when the ADF picks more than one sheet of media at
once.
Error Prevention
Jam Assist
O
On*
Set the printer to check for jammed paper automatically.
Error Prevention
Auto Continue
O
On*
Auto Continue Time (5*)
Let the printer continue processing or printing a job
automatically after clearing certain attendance conditions.
Error Prevention
Auto Reboot
Auto Reboot
Reboot when idle
Reboot always*
Reboot never
Set the printer to restart when an error occurs.
Error Prevention
Auto Reboot
Max Auto Reboots (2*)
Set the number of automatic reboots that the printer can
perform.
Error Prevention
Auto Reboot
Auto Reboot Window (720*)
Set the number of seconds before the printer performs an
automatic reboot.
Error Prevention
Auto Reboot
Auto Reboot Counter
Show a readonly information of the reboot counter.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 127
background
Menu item Description
Error Prevention
Auto Reboot
Reset Auto Reboot Counter
Cancel
Continue
Reset Auto Reboot Counter.
Error Prevention
Display Short Paper Error
On
Autoclear*
Set the printer to show a message when a short paper error
occurs.
Note: Short paper refers to the size of the paper loaded.
Error Prevention
Page Protect
O*
On
Set the printer to process the entire page into the memory
before printing it.
Jam Content Recovery
Jam Recovery
O
On
Auto*
Set the printer to reprint jammed pages.
Jam Content Recovery
Scanner Jam Recovery
Job level
Page level*
Specify how to restart a scan job after resolving a paper jam.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Power Management
Menu item Description
Sleep Mode Profile
Print from Sleep Mode
Stay awake after printing
Enter Sleep Mode after printing*
Set the printer to stay awake or enter Sleep mode after
printing.
Sleep Mode Profile
Touch to Wake from Deep Sleep
O
On*
Wake the printer from Deep Sleep mode by touching the
printer display.
Timeouts
Sleep Mode
1–114 minutes (15*)
Set the idle time before the printer begins operating in Sleep
mode.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 128
background
Menu item Description
Timeouts
Hibernate Timeout
Disabled
1 hour
2 hours
3 hours
6 hours
1 day
2 days
3 days*
1 week
2 weeks
1 month
Set the time before the printer turns o.
Timeouts
Hibernate Timeout on Connection
Hibernate
Do Not Hibernate*
Set Hibernate Timeout to turn o the printer while an active
Ethernet connection exists.
Schedule Power Modes
Schedules
Add New Schedule
Schedule the printer when to enter Sleep or Hibernate mode.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Anonymous Data Collection
Menu item Description
Anonymous Data Collection
Device Usage and Performance
Information
None*
Send printer usage and performance information to Lexmark.
Note: Anonymous Data Send Time appears only when you set
Anonymous Data Collection to Device Usage and Performance
Information.
Anonymous Data Send Time
Start Time
Stop Time
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Accessibility
Menu item Description
Duplicate Key Strike Interval
0–5 (0*)
Set the interval in seconds during which the printer ignores duplicate key
presses on an attached keyboard.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 129
background
Menu item Description
Key Repeat Initial Delay
0.255 (1*)
Set the initial length of delay in seconds before a repeating key starts
repeating.
Note: This menu item appears only when a keyboard is attached to the
printer.
Key Repeat Rate
0.5–30 (30*)
Set the number of presses per second for a repeating key.
Note: This menu item appears only when a keyboard is attached to the
printer.
Prolong Screen Timeout
O*
On
Let the user remain in the same location and reset the Screen Timeout
timer when it expires instead of returning to the home screen.
Headphone Volume
1–10 (5*)
Adjust the headphone volume.
Note: This menu item appears only when a headphone is attached to
the printer.
Enable Voice Guidance When
Headphone Is Attached
O*
On
Enable Voice Guidance when a headphone is attached to the printer.
Speak Passwords/PINs
O*
On
Set the printer to read out loud passwords or personal identification
numbers.
Note: This menu item appears only when a headphone or a speaker is
attached to the printer.
Speech Rate
Very Slow
Slow
Normal*
Fast
Faster
Very Fast
Rapid
Very Rapid
Fastest
Set the Voice Guidance speech rate.
Note: This menu item appears only when a headphone or a speaker is
attached to the printer.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Restore Factory Defaults
Menu item Description
Restore Settings
Restore all settings
Restore printer settings
Restore network settings
Restore fax settings
Restore app settings
Restore the printer factory default settings.
Use printer menus 130
background
Maintenance
Configuration Menu
Menu item Description
USB Configuration
USB PnP
1*
2
Change the USB driver mode of the printer to improve its
compatibility with a personal computer.
USB Configuration
USB Scan to Local
On*
O
Set whether the USB device driver enumerates as a USB
Simple device (single interface) or as a USB Composite device
(multiple interfaces).
USB Configuration
USB Speed
Full
Auto*
Set the USB port to run at full speed and disable its highspeed
capabilities.
Tray Conguration
Size Sensing
Tray [x] Sensing
O
On*
Set the tray to sense automatically the paper size loaded into
it.
Tray Conguration
Tray Linking
Automatic*
O
Set the printer to link the trays that have the same paper type
and paper size settings.
Tray Conguration
Show Tray Insert Message
O
Only for unknown sizes*
Always
Display a message that lets the user change the paper size and
paper type settings after inserting the tray.
Tray Conguration
A5 Loading
Short Edge
Long Edge*
Determine the default loading orientation for the A5 size paper
in all paper sources.
Tray Conguration
Paper Prompts
Auto*
Multipurpose Feeder
Manual Paper
Set the paper source that the user fills when a prompt to load
paper appears.
Note: For Multipurpose Feeder to appear, in the Paper menu,
set Configure MP to Cassette.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 131
background
Menu item Description
Tray Conguration
Envelope Prompts
Auto*
Multipurpose Feeder
Manual Envelope
Set the paper source that the user fills when a prompt to load
envelope appears.
Note: For Multipurpose Feeder to appear, in the Paper menu,
set Configure MP to Cassette.
Tray Conguration
Action for Prompts
Prompt user*
Continue
Use current
Set the printer to resolve paper- or envelope-related change
prompts.
Tray Conguration
Multiple Universal Sizes
O*
On
Set the tray to support multiple universal paper sizes.
Reports
Menu Settings Page
Event Log
Event Log Summary
Print reports about printer menu settings, status, and event
logs.
Supply Usage And Counters
Clear Supply Usage History
Reset the supply usage history, such as number of pages and
days remaining, to the factory shipped level.
Supply Usage And Counters
ITM Reset
Reset Black Cartridge Counter
Reset Cyan Cartridge Counter
Reset Magenta Cartridge Counter
Reset Yellow Cartridge Counter
Reset Maintenance Counter
Reset the counter after installing a new supply item or
maintenance kit.
Supply Usage And Counters
Tiered Coverage Ranges
Adjust the amount of color coverage for each printing range.
Printer Emulations
PPDS Emulation
O*
On
Set the printer to recognize and use the PPDS data stream.
Printer Emulations
PS Emulation
O
On*
Set the printer to recognize and use the PS data stream.
Printer Emulations
Enable Formsmerge
O*
On
Activate formsmerge to store the forms into the hard disk or
intelligent storage drive (ISD).
Note: The printer must have a hard disk or an ISD installed.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 132
background
Menu item Description
Printer Emulations
Enable Prescribe
O*
On
Activate Prescribe.
Note: The Prescribe license must be installed.
Printer Emulations
Emulator Security
Page Timeout
0–60 (60*)
Set the page timeout during emulation.
Printer Emulations
Emulator Security
Reset Emulator After Job
O*
On
Reset the emulator after a print job.
Printer Emulations
Emulator Security
Disable Printer Message Access
O
On*
Disable access to printer message during emulation.
Fax Configuration
Fax Low Power Support
Disable Sleep
Permit Sleep
Auto*
Set fax to enter Sleep mode whenever the printer determines
that it must.
Fax Configuration
Fax Storage Location
NAND
Disk*
Set the storage location for all faxes.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an
ISD is installed.
Print Configuration
Black Only Mode
O*
On
Print noncopy jobs in grayscale.
Print Configuration
Color Trapping
O
1
2*
3
4
5
Enhance the printed output to compensate for misregistration
in the printer.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 133
background
Menu item Description
Print Configuration
Font Sharpening
0–150 (24*)
Set a text point-size value below which the highfrequency
screens are used when printing font data.
For example, if the value is 24, then all fonts sized 24 points or
less use the highfrequency screens.
Device Operations
Quiet Mode
O*
On
Set the printer to operate in Quiet Mode.
Note: Enabling this setting slows down the overall
performance of the printer.
Device Operations
Panel Menus
O
On*
Enable access to the printer menus from the control panel.
Device Operations
Safe Mode
O*
On
Set the printer to operate in a special mode, in which it attempts
to continue oering as much functionality as possible, despite
known issues.
For example, when set to On, and the duplex motor is
nonfunctional, the printer performs onesided printing of the
documents even if the job is twosided printing.
Device Operations
Minimum Copy Memory
80 MB*
100 MB
Set the minimum memory allocation for storing copy jobs.
Device Operations
Clear Custom Status
Erase userdefined strings for the Default or Alternate custom
messages.
Device Operations
Clear all remotelyinstalled messages
Erase messages that were remotely installed.
Device Operations
Automatically Display Error Screens
O
On*
Show existing error messages on the display after the printer
remains inactive on the home screen for a length of time.
Device Operations
Honor orientation on fast path copy
O*
On
Enable the printer to use the orientation setting under the Copy
menu when sending quick copy jobs.
Toner patch sensor setup
Calibration frequency preference
Disabled
Fewest color adjustments
Fewer color adjustments
Normal*
Better color accuracy
Best color accuracy
Set how often color calibration and color alignment is
performed.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 134
background
Menu item Description
Toner patch sensor setup
Full calibration
Run the full color calibration.
Toner patch sensor setup
Print TPS information page
Print a diagnostic page that contains information on toner patch
sensor calibration.
App Configuration
LES Applications
O
On*
Enable Lexmark Embedded Solutions (LES) applications.
Scanner Configuration
Scanner Manual Registration
Print Quick Test
Print a Quick Test target page.
Note: Make sure that the margin spacing on the target page
is uniform all the way around the target. If it is not, then the
printer margins must be reset.
Scanner Configuration
Scanner Manual Registration
Front ADF Registration
Rear ADF Registration
Flatbed Registration
Manually register the flatbed and ADF after replacing the ADF,
scanner glass, or controller board.
Scanner Configuration
Reset Maintenance Counter
Reset the counter after replacing the ADF maintenance kit.
Scanner Configuration
Edge Erase
Flatbed Edge Erase (3*)
ADF Edge Erase (3*)
Set the size, in millimeters, of the noprint area around an ADF
or flatbed scan job.
Scanner Configuration
ADF Deskew
ADF Electronic Deskew (On*)
Reduce skewing of documents that are scanned from the ADF.
Scanner Configuration
Disable Scanner
No*
Ye s
ADF Only
Disable the scanner when it is not working properly.
Scanner Configuration
Ti Byte Order
CPU Endianness*
Little Endian
Big Endian
Set the byte order of a TIFFformatted scan output.
Scanner Configuration
Exact Ti Rows Per Strip
On*
O
Set the RowsPerStrip tag value of a TIFFformatted scan output.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 135
background
Menu item Description
Scanner Configuration
Scanner Glass Cleaning Threshold
1000–30000, 0=Disabled (10000*)
Set the number of scans before the user receives a prompt to
clean the scanner glass.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Out of Service Erase
Menu item Description
Out of Service Erase
Memory Last Sanitized
Hard Disk Last Sanitized
ISD last erased
Show a readonly information on when the printer
memory or storage drive was last erased.
Note: Hard Disk Last Sanitized and ISD last erased
appear only when a storage drive is installed.
Out of Service Erase
Sanitize all information on nonvolatile memory
Erase all printer and network settings
Erase all apps and app settings
Erase all shortcuts and shortcut settings
Sanitize all information on hard disk
Erase downloads (Erase all macros, fonts, PFOs, etc.)
Erase buered jobs
Erase Held jobs
Erase Intelligent Storage Drive
Clear all information on nonvolatile memory and on
the storage drive.
Note: Sanitize all information on hard disk and
Erase Intelligent Storage Drive appear only when a
storage drive is installed.
Home Screen Customization
Note: This menu appears only in the Embedded Web Server.
Use printer menus 136
background
Menu Description
Copy
E-mail
Fax
Held Faxes
Release Held Faxes
Status/Supplies
Job Queue
Settings
Change Language
Address Book
Bookmarks
Held Jobs
USB Drive
FTP
Scan Profiles
Lock Device
Scan Center
Card Copy
Shortcut Center
Specify which icons to show on the home screen.
Update firmware
Menu item Description
Current Version Show the current firmware version installed on the printer.
Check for updates now Check for firmware updates.
Auto check for updates
On
O*
Set the printer to check for firmware updates automatically.
About this Printer
Menu item Description
Asset Tag Specify the identity of the printer. The maximum length is 32 characters.
Printer’s Location Specify the printer location. The maximum length is 63 characters.
Contact Specify the contact information for the printer. The maximum length is 63
characters.
Firmware Version Show the firmware version installed on the printer.
Engine Show the engine number of the printer.
Serial Number Show the serial number of the printer.
Export Configuration File to
USB
Export the configuration file to a flash drive.
Use printer menus 137
background
Menu item Description
Export Compressed Logs to
USB
Export the compressed log files to a flash drive.
Send Logs Send printer log information to Lexmark.
Print
Layout
Menu item Description
Sides
1Sided*
2Sided
Specify whether to print on one side or both sides of the paper.
Flip Style
Long Edge*
Short Edge
Determine which side of the paper is bound when performing twosided printing.
Blank Pages
Print
Do Not Print*
Print blank pages that are included in a print job.
Collate
O
(1,1,1,2,2,2)
On (1,2,1,2,1,2)*
Keep the pages of a print job stacked in sequence, particularly when printing multiple
copies of the job.
Separator Sheets
None*
Between Copies
Between Jobs
Between Pages
Insert blank separator sheets when printing.
Separator Sheet Source
Tray [x] (1*)
Multipurpose Feeder
Specify the paper source for the separator sheet.
Pages per Side
O*
2 pages per side
3 pages per side
4 pages per side
6 pages per side
9 pages per side
12 pages per side
16 pages per side
Print multiple page images on one side of a sheet of paper.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 138
background
Menu item Description
Pages per Side Ordering
Horizontal*
Reverse Horizontal
Vertical
Reverse Vertical
Specify the positioning of multiple page images when using the Pages per Side menu.
Pages per Side Orientation
Auto*
Landscape
Portrait
Specify the orientation of multiple page images when using the Pages per Side menu.
Pages per Side Border
None*
Solid
Print a border around each page image when using the Pages per Side menu.
Copies
1–9999 (1*)
Specify the number of copies for each print job.
Print Area
Normal*
Fit to page
Whole Page
Set the printable area on a sheet of paper.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Setup
Menu item Description
Printer Language
PCL Emulation
PS Emulation*
Set the printer language.
Note: Setting a printer language default does not prevent a software
program from sending print jobs that use another printer language.
Job Waiting
O*
On
Preserve print jobs requiring supplies so that jobs not requiring the missing
supplies can print.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an intelligent
storage drive (ISD) is installed.
Job Hold Timeout
0–255 (30*)
Set the time in seconds that the printer waits for user intervention before
it holds jobs that require unavailable resources.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is
installed.
Printer Usage
Max Speed
Max Yield*
Determine how the color imaging kit operates during printing.
Notes:
When set to Max Yield, the color imaging kit slows or stops while
printing groups of black-only pages.
When set to Max Speed, the color imaging kit always runs while
printing, whether color or black pages are being printed.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 139
background
Menu item Description
LowSpeed Printer Usage
Max Speed
Max Yield*
Determine how the color imaging kit operates during lowspeed printing.
Notes:
When set to Max Yield, the color imaging kit slows or stops while
printing groups of black-only pages.
When set to Max Speed, the color imaging kit always runs while
printing, whether color or black pages are being printed.
This setting only changes printer behavior when the print engine is
running at a 25 pages per minute process speed. It has no eect
when the print engine is running at faster process speeds.
Download Target
RAM*
Flash
Disk
Specify where to save all permanent resources that have been
downloaded to the printer.
Note: Flash and Disk appear only when a hard disk or an ISD is installed.
Resource Save
O*
On
Determine what the printer does with downloaded resources when it
receives a job that requires more than the available memory.
Notes:
When set to O, the printer retains downloaded resources only until
memory is needed. Resources associated with the inactive printer
language are deleted.
When set to On, the printer preserves all the permanent
downloaded resources across all language switches. When
necessary, the printer shows memory full messages instead of
deleting permanent resources.
Print All Order
Alphabetical*
Newest First
Oldest First
Specify the order when you choose to print all held and confidential jobs.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is
installed.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Quality
Menu item Description
Print Mode
Black and White
Color*
Set how the printer generates color content.
Print Resolution
4800 CQ*
1200 dpi
Set the resolution for the printed output.
Note: 4800 CQ provides highquality output at maximum speed.
Toner Darkness
1 to 5 (4*)
Determine the lightness or darkness of text images.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 140
background
Menu item Description
Halftone
Normal*
Detail
Enhance the printed output to have smoother lines with sharper edges.
Color Saver
O*
On
Reduce the amount of toner used to print graphics and images.
Note: When set to On, this setting overrides the value of the Toner Darkness
setting.
RGB Brightness
6 to 6 (0*)
Adjust the brightness of every RGB and gray object on the page.
Note: This setting does not aect files where CMYK color specifications are
used.
RGB Contrast
0 to 5 (0*)
Adjust the contrast of every RGB and gray object on a page.
Note: This setting does not
aect
files
where CMYK color
specifications
are
used.
RGB Saturation
0 to 5 (0*)
Preserve the black and white values while adjusting the color values of every
object on the page.
Note: This setting does not
aect
files
where CMYK color
specifications
are
used.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Advanced Imaging
Menu item Description
Color Balance
Cyan (0*)
Magenta (0*)
Ye l l o w ( 0 * )
Black (0*)
Adjust the amount of toner that is used for each color.
Color Balance
Reset Defaults
Reset all color settings to their default values.
Color Correction
O
Auto*
Manual
Modify the color settings used to print documents.
Notes:
O sets the printer to receive the color correction from the software.
Auto sets the printer to apply
dierent
color
profiles
to each object on the
printed page.
Manual allows the customization of the RGB or CMYK color conversions
applied to each object on the printed page.
Color Samples
Print Color Samples
Print sample pages for each of the RGB and CMYK color conversion tables used
in the printer.
Color Adjust Calibrate the printer to adjust color variations in the printed output.
Spot Color Replacement
Set Custom CMYK
Assign specific CMYK values to twenty named spot colors.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 141
background
Job Accounting
Menu item Description
Job Accounting
O*
On
Set the printer to create a log of the print jobs that it receives.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an intelligent storage
drive (ISD) is installed.
Accounting Log Frequency
Daily
Weekly
Monthly*
Specify how often the printer creates a log file.
Log Action at End of Frequency
None*
Email Current Log
Email & Delete Current Log
Post Current Log
Post & Delete Current Log
Specify how the printer responds when the frequency threshold expires.
Note: The value defined in Accounting Log Frequency determines when this
action is triggered.
Log Near Full Level
O
On (5)*
Specify the maximum size of the log file before the printer executes the Log
Action at Near Full.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is installed.
Log Action at Near Full
None*
Email Current Log
Email & Delete Current Log
Email & Delete Oldest Log
Post Current Log
Post & Delete Current Log
Post & Delete Oldest Log
Delete Current Log
Delete Oldest Log
Delete All But Current
Delete All Logs
Specify how the printer responds when the hard disk or ISD is nearly full.
Note: The value
defined
in Log Near Full Level determines when this action
is triggered.
Log Action at Full
None*
Email & Delete Current Log
Email & Delete Oldest Log
Post & Delete Current Log
Post & Delete Oldest Log
Delete Current Log
Delete Oldest Log
Delete All But Current
Delete All Logs
Specify how the printer responds when hard disk or ISD usage reaches the
maximum limit (100MB).
URL to Post Log Specify where the printer posts job accounting logs.
Email Address to Send Logs Specify the email address to which the printer sends job accounting logs.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 142
background
Menu item Description
Log File Prefix Specify the prefix for the log files.
Note: The current host name
defined
in the TCP/IP menu is used as the
default log
file
prefix.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
PDF
Menu item Description
Scale To Fit
O*
On
Scale the page content to fit the selected paper size.
Annotations
Print
Do Not Print*
Specify whether to print annotations in the PDF.
Print PDF Error
O
On*
Enable the printing of PDF error.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
PostScript
Menu item Description
Print PS Error
O*
On
Print a page that describes the PostScript® error.
Note: When an error occurs, processing of the job stops, the printer
prints an error message, and the rest of the print job is flushed.
Minimum Line Width
1–30 (2*)
Set the minimum stroke width.
Note: Jobs printed in 1200 dpi use the value directly.
Lock PS Startup Mode
O
On*
Disable the SysStart file.
Note: Enabling the SysStart
file
exposes your printer or network to a
security risk.
Image Smoothing
O*
On
Enhance the contrast and sharpness of lowresolution images.
Note: This setting has no
eect
on images with a resolution of 300 dpi or
higher.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 143
background
Menu item Description
Font Priority
Resident*
Flash/Disk
Establish the font search order.
Notes:
Resident sets the printer to search its memory for the requested font
before searching the hard disk or intelligent storage drive (ISD).
Flash/Disk sets the printer to search the hard disk or ISD for the
requested font before searching the printer memory.
This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is installed.
Wait Timeout
O
On* (40 seconds)
Enable the printer to wait for more data before canceling a print job.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
PCL
Menu item Description
Font Source
Resident*
Disk
Download
Flash
Font Card
All
Select the source which contains the default font selection.
Notes:
Disk and Flash appear only when a hard disk or an intelligent storage
drive (ISD) that contains fonts is installed.
Download appears only if downloaded fonts exist in the printer
memory.
Font Card appears only when an ISD is installed.
Font Name
[List of available fonts] (Courier*)
Select a font from the specified font source.
Symbol Set
[List of available symbol set] (10U
PC8*)
Specify the symbol set for each font name.
Note: A symbol set is a set of alphabetic and numeric characters,
punctuation, and special symbols. Symbol sets support the dierent
languages or specific programs such as math symbols for scientific text.
Pitch
0.08–100.00 (10.00*)
Specify the pitch for fixed or monospaced fonts.
Note: Pitch refers to the number of fixedspace characters in a horizontal
inch of type.
Orientation
Portrait*
Landscape
Reverse Portrait
Reverse Landscape
Specify the orientation of text and graphics on the page.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 144
background
Menu item Description
Lines per Page
1–255
Specify the number of lines of text for each page printed through the PCL®
data stream.
Notes:
This menu item activates vertical escapement that causes the
selected number of requested lines to print between the default
margins of the page.
60 is the U.S. factory default setting. 64 is the international factory
default setting.
PCL5 Minimum Line Width
1–30 (2*)
Set the initial minimum stroke width.
PCLXL Minimum Line Width
1–30 (2*)
A4 Width
198 mm*
203 mm
Set the width of the logical page on A4size paper.
Note: Logical page is the space on the physical page where data is
printed.
Auto CR after LF
On
O*
Set the printer to perform a carriage return after a line feed control
command.
Note: Carriage return is a mechanism that commands the printer to move
the position of the cursor to the first position on the same line.
Auto LF after CR
On
O*
Set the printer to perform a line feed after a carriage return control
command.
Tray Renumber
Assign MP Feeder
Assign Tray [x]
Assign Manual Paper
Assign Manual Envelope
Configure the printer to work with a dierent print driver or custom
application that uses a dierent set of source assignments to request a
given paper source.
Choose from the following options:
O*—The
printer uses the factory default paper source assignments.
None—The paper source ignores the Select Paper Feed command.
0–199—Select a numeric value to assign a custom value to a paper
source.
Tray Renumber
View Factory Defaults
Show the factory default value assigned for each paper source.
Tray Renumber
Restore Defaults
Restore the tray renumber values to their factory defaults.
Print Timeout
O
On* (90 seconds)
Set the printer to end a print job after it has been idle for the specified
amount of time.
Note: Print Timeout Time appears only when Print Timeout is enabled.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 145
background
Image
Menu item Description
Auto Fit
On
O*
Select the best available paper size and orientation setting for an image.
Note: When set to On, this menu item overrides the scaling and orientation
settings for the image.
Invert
O*
On
Invert bitonal monochrome images.
Note: This menu item does not apply to GIF or JPEG image formats.
Scaling
Anchor Top Left
Best Fit*
Anchor Center
Fit Height/Width
Fit Height
Fit Width
Adjust the image to fit the printable area.
Note: When Auto Fit is set to On, Scaling is automatically set to Best Fit.
Orientation
Portrait*
Landscape
Reverse Portrait
Reverse Landscape
Specify the orientation of text and graphics on the page.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Paper
Tray Conguration
Menu item Description
Default Source
Tray [x] (1*)
Multipurpose Feeder
Manual Paper
Manual Envelope
Set the paper source for all print jobs.
Paper Size/Type
Tray [x]
Multipurpose Feeder
Manual Paper
Manual Envelope
Specify the paper size or paper type loaded in each paper source.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 146
background
Menu item Description
Substitute Size
O
Letter/A4
All Listed*
Set the printer to substitute a specified paper size if the requested size is not
loaded in any paper source.
Notes:
O prompts the user to load the required paper size.
All Listed allows all available substitutions.
Configure MP
Cassette*
Manual
First
Determine the behavior of the multipurpose feeder.
Notes:
Cassette configures the multipurpose feeder as the automatic paper
source.
Manual sets the multipurpose feeder only for manual-feed print jobs.
First configures the multipurpose feeder as the primary paper source.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Media Configuration
Universal Setup
Menu item Description
Units of Measure
Inches
Millimeters
Specify the unit of measurement for the universal paper.
Note: Inches is the U.S. factory default setting. Millimeters is the
international factory default setting.
Portrait Width
3.00–52.00 inches (8.5*)
76–1321 mm (216*)
Set the portrait width of the universal paper.
Portrait Height
3.00–52.00 inches (14*)
76–1321 mm (356*)
Set the portrait height of the universal paper.
Feed Direction
Short Edge*
Long Edge
Set the printer to pick paper from the short edge or long edge
direction.
Note: Long Edge appears only when the longest edge is shorter
than the maximum width supported.
Multiple Universal Sizes
Tray [x]
Multipurpose Feeder
Assign a unique dimension for multiple universal sizes that are loaded
in each paper source.
Note: This setting appears only when enabled in the Device menu.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Maintenance >
Configuration Menu > Tray Conguration > Multiple Universal
Sizes.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 147
background
Custom Scan Sizes
Menu item Description
Custom Scan Size [x]
Scan Size Name
Width
1–8.5 inches (8.5*)
25–216 mm (216*)
Height
1–25 inches (11*)
25–635 mm (279*)
Orientation
Portrait*
Landscape
2 scans per side
O*
On
Assign a scan size name and configure the scan settings.
Media Types
Menu item Description
Plain Paper
Card Stock
Recycled
Glossy
Labels
Vinyl Labels
Bond
Envelope
Letterhead
Preprinted
Colored Paper
Light Paper
Heavy Paper
Rough/Cotton
Custom Type [X]
Specify the texture, weight, and orientation of the paper.
Use printer menus 148
background
Copy
Copy Defaults
Menu item Description
Content Type
Te xt
Te xt /P ho to *
Photo
Graphics
Improve the output result based on the content of the original document.
Content Source
Black and White Laser
Color Laser*
Inkjet
Photo/Film
Magazine
Newspaper
Press
Other
Improve the output result based on the source of the original document.
Sides
1 sided to 1 sided*
1 sided to 2 sided
2 sided to 1 sided
2 sided to 2 sided
Specify the scanning behavior based on the original document.
Separator Sheets
None*
Between Copies
Between Jobs
Between Pages
Specify whether to insert blank separator sheets when printing.
Separator Sheet Source
Tray [x] (1*)
Multipurpose Feeder
Specify the paper source for the separator sheet.
Color
O
On*
Auto
Set the printer to generate color output from a scan job.
Pages per Side
O*
2 Portrait pages
4 Portrait pages
2 Landscape pages
4 Landscape pages
Specify the number of page images to print on one side of a sheet of paper.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 149
background
Menu item Description
Print Page Borders
O*
On
Place a border around each image when printing multiple pages on a single
page.
Collate
O
[1,1,1,2,2,2]
On [1,2,1,2,1,2]*
Print multiple copies in sequence.
“Copy from” Size
[List of paper sizes]
Set the paper size of the original document.
Note: Letter is the U.S. factory default setting. A4 is the international factory
default setting.
“Copy to” Source
Tray [x] (1*)
Multipurpose Feeder
Auto Size Match
Specify the paper source for the copy job.
Temp erature
4 to 4 (0*)
Specify whether to generate a cooler or warmer output.
Darkness
1 to 9 (5*)
Adjust the darkness of the scanned image.
Number of Copies
1–9999 (1*)
Specify the number of copies.
Header/Footer
Left Header
Middle Header
Right Header
Left Footer
Middle Footer
Right Footer
Specify the header or footer information on the scanned image.
Overlay
Confidential
Copy
Draft
Urgent
Custom
O*
Specify the overlay text to print on each copy.
Custom overlay Type the text for the Custom choice in the Overlay menu.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 150
background
Advanced Imaging
Menu item Description
Color Balance
Cyan (0*
Magenta (0*)
Ye l l o w ( 0 * )
Adjust the color intensity for cyan, magenta, and yellow.
Color Dropout
Color Dropout (None*)
Default Red Threshold (128*)
Default Green Threshold (128*)
Default Blue Threshold(128*)
Specify which color to drop during scanning, and adjust the dropout
setting for that color.
Auto Color Detect
Color Sensitivity (5*)
Area Sensitivity (5*)
Configure the auto color detection setting.
Contrast
Best for content*
0–5
Specify the contrast for the scanned image.
Background Removal
Background Detection (Contentbased*)
Level (0*)
Remove the background color or image noise from the original
document.
Notes:
Content-based removes the background color from the original
document .
Fixed removes image noise from a photo.
Auto Center
O*
On
Align the content at the center of the page.
Mirror Image
O*
On
Create a mirror image of the original document.
Negative Image
O*
On
Create a negative image of the original document.
Shadow Detail
4 to 4 (0*)
Adjust the shadow detail in the original document.
Scan Edge to Edge
O*
On
Scan the original document from edge to edge.
Sharpness
1–5 (3*)
Adjust the sharpness of the scanned image.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 151
background
Admin Controls
Menu item Description
Allow Color Copies
O
On*
Print copies in color.
Allow Priority Copies
O
On*
Interrupt a print job to make copies.
Custom Job Scanning
O*
On
Set the printer to scan the first set of original documents using the specified
settings, and then scan the next set with the same or dierent settings.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an intelligent storage
drive (ISD) is installed.
Allow Save as Shortcut
O
On*
Save copy settings as a shortcut.
Adjust ADF Skew
O
On*
Set the printer to adjust the skewed images from documents that are scanned
from the ADF.
Sample copy
O*
On
Print a sample copy to check the quality before printing the remaining copies.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is installed.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Fax
Fax Defaults
Fax Mode
Menu item Description
Fax Mode
Fax
Fax Server
Disabled
Select a fax mode.
Note: Depending on your printer model, the factory default
setting may vary.
Use printer menus 152
background
Fax Setup
General Fax settings
Menu item Description
Fax Name Specify your fax ID.
Fax Number Specify your fax number.
Fax ID
Fax Name
Fax Number*
Set the fax ID to use during fax negotiation.
Enable Manual Fax
O*
On
Turn on the manual fax function in the printer.
Notes:
This menu item requires a line splitter and a telephone handset.
Use a regular telephone line to answer an incoming fax job and to dial a
fax number.
To go directly to the manual fax function, touch # and 0 on the keypad.
Memory Use
All receive
Mostly receive
Equal*
Mostly send
All send
Set the amount of internal printer memory allocated for faxing.
Note: This menu item prevents memory
buer
conditions and failed faxes.
Cancel Faxes
Allow*
Don't Allow
Cancel outgoing or incoming faxes.
Fax Number Masking
O*
From Left
From Right
Specify the format for masking an outgoing fax number.
Digits to Mask
0–58 (0*)
Specify the number of digits to mask in an outgoing fax number.
Enable Line Connected
Detection
O
On*
Determine whether a telephone line is connected to the printer.
Note: Events are detected immediately.
Enable Line In Wrong Jack
Detection
O
On*
Determine whether a telephone line is connected to the correct port on the
printer.
Note: Events are detected immediately.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 153
background
Menu item Description
Enable Extension in Use
Support
O
On*
Determine whether a telephone line is used by another device, such as another
phone on the same line.
Note: Events are detected immediately.
Optimize Fax Compatibility Configure the printer fax functionality for optimal compatibility with other fax
machines.
Fax Transport
T.38
Analog
G.711
etherFAX
Set the fax transport method.
Note: This menu item appears only if an etherFAX or Fax over IP (FoIP) license
bundle is installed in the printer.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
HTTPS Fax Settings
Note: This menu appears only if Fax Transport is set to etherFAX.
Menu item Description
HTTPS service URL Specify the etherFAX service URL.
HTTPS Proxy Specify a proxy server URL.
HTTPS Proxy User Specify the user name and password for the proxy server.
HTTPS Proxy Password
Fax Send Encryption
Disabled
Enabled*
Required
Enable encryption for outgoing fax messages.
Fax Receive Encryption
Disabled
Enabled*
Required
Enable encryption for incoming fax messages.
HTTPS Fax Status Show the etherFAX communication status.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Fax Send Settings
Menu item Description
Resolution
Standard*
Fine
Super Fine
Ultra Fine
Set the resolution of the scanned image.
Note: A higher resolution increases fax transmission time and requires more
memory.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 154
background
Menu item Description
Original Size
[List of paper sizes] (Mixed
Sizes*)
Specify the size of the original document.
Orientation
Portrait*
Landscape
Specify the orientation of the original document.
Sides
O*
Short Edge
Long Edge
Specify the orientation of the original document when scanning on both sides
of the document.
Content Type
Te xt *
Te xt /P ho to
Photo
Graphics
Improve the output result based on the content of the original document.
Content Source
Black and White Laser
Color Laser*
Inkjet
Photo/Film
Magazine
Newspaper
Press
Other
Improve the output result based on the source of the original document.
Darkness
1–9 (5*)
Adjust the darkness of the scanned image.
Behind a PABX
On
O*
Set the printer to dial a fax number without waiting to recognize the dial tone.
Note: Private Automated Branch Exchange (PABX) is a telephone network that
allows a single access number to oer multiple lines to outside callers.
Dial Mode
To ne*
Pulse
Specify the dial mode for incoming or outgoing faxes.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 155
background
Advanced Imaging
Menu item Description
Color Balance
Cyan Red
-4 to 4 (0*)
Magenta Green
-4 to 4 (0*)
Ye l l o w Blue
-4 to 4 (0*)
Adjust the color intensity during scanning.
Color Dropout
Color Dropout (None*)
Default Red Threshold (128*)
Default Green Threshold
(128*)
Default Blue Threshold (128*)
Specify which color to drop during scanning, and adjust the dropout setting for
that color.
Contrast
Best for Content*
0
1
2
3
4
5
Set the contrast of the output.
Background Removal
Level
4 to 4 (0*)
Adjust the amount of background visible on a scanned image.
Mirror Image
O*
On
Create a mirror image of the original document.
Negative Image
O*
On
Create a negative image of the original document.
Shadow Detail
4 to 4 (0*)
Adjust the amount of shadow detail visible on a scanned image.
Scan Edge to Edge
On
O*
Allow edgetoedge scanning of the original document.
Sharpness
1–5 (3*)
Adjust the sharpness of the scanned image.
Temp erature
4 to 4 (0*)
Specify whether to generate a cooler or warmer output.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 156
background
Admin Controls
Menu item Description
Automatic Redial
0–9 (5*)
Specify the number of attempts that the printer redials before it cancels sending
the fax to a specified destination.
Redial Frequency
1–200 minutes (3*)
Increase the time between redial attempts to increase the chance of sending
fax successfully.
Enable ECM
On*
O
Activate Error Correction Mode (ECM) for fax jobs.
Note: ECM detects and corrects errors in the fax transmission process caused
by telephone line noise and poor signal strength.
Enable Fax Scans
On*
O
Create faxes using the printer scanner.
Driver to Fax
On*
O
Allow the print driver to send fax.
Allow Save as Shortcut
On*
O
Save fax numbers as shortcuts on the printer.
Max Speed
33600*
14400
9600
4800
2400
Set the maximum speed for sending fax.
Custom Job Scanning
O*
On
Turn on scanning of custom jobs by default.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an intelligent storage
drive (ISD) is installed.
Scan Preview
O*
On
Show a preview of the scan on the display.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is installed.
Adjust ADF Skew
O
On*
Correct slight skew in the scanned image.
Enable Color Fax Scans
O
by Default*
On by Default
Never Use
Always Use
Enable color scans for fax.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 157
background
Menu item Description
Auto Convert Color Faxes to
Mono Faxes
On*
O
Convert all outgoing color faxes to black and white.
Confirm Fax Number
O*
On
Ask the user to confirm the fax number.
Dial Prefix Set a dialing prefix.
Dialing Prefix Rules Establish a dialing prefix rule.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Fax Receive Settings
Menu item Description
Fax Job Waiting
None*
To ne r
Toner and Supplies
Remove fax jobs that request specific unavailable resources from the print
queue.
Rings to Answer
1–25 (3*)
Set the number of rings required before the printer answers the incoming
calls.
Auto Reduction
On*
O
Scale incoming fax to fit on the page.
Paper Source
Tray [X]
Auto*
Set the paper source for printing incoming fax.
Sides
On
O*
Print on both sides of the paper.
Separator Sheets
None*
Before Job
After Job
Specify whether to insert blank separator sheets when printing.
Separator Sheet Source
Tray [X] (1*)
Specify the paper source for the separator sheet.
Output Bin
Standard Bin
Specify the output bin for received faxes.
Fax Footer
On
O*
Print the transmission information at the bottom of each page from a received
fax.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 158
background
Menu item Description
Fax Footer Time Stamp
Receive*
Print
Print the time stamp at the bottom of each page from a received fax.
Holding Faxes
Held Fax Mode
O*
Always On
Manual
Scheduled
Hold received faxes from printing until they are released.
Holding Faxes
Fax Holding Schedule
Assign a schedule for holding faxes.
Note: This menu item appears only if Held Fax Mode is set to Scheduled.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Admin Controls
Menu item Description
Enable Fax Receive
On*
O
Set the printer to receive fax.
Enable Color Fax Receive
On*
O
Set the printer to receive fax in color.
Enable Caller ID
On
O*
Show the caller ID information of the incoming call on the printer display.
Block No Name Fax
On
O*
Block incoming faxes without fax IDs.
Banned Fax List
Add Banned Fax
Specify the phone numbers that you want to block.
Answer On
All Rings*
Single Ring Only
Double Ring Only
Triple Ring Only
Single or Double Rings Only
Single or Triple Rings Only
Double or Triple Rings Only
Set a distinctive ring pattern for incoming fax.
Auto Answer
On*
O
Set the printer to receive fax automatically.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 159
background
Menu item Description
Manual Answer Code
0–9 (9*)
Manually enter a code on the telephone number pad to begin receiving fax.
Notes:
This menu item appears only when the printer shares a line with a
telephone.
This menu item appears only when you set the printer to receive fax
manually.
Fax Forwarding
Print*
Print and Forward
Forward
Specify whether to forward received fax.
Forward To
Destination 1
Destination 2
Specify where to forward received fax.
Note: This menu item appears only when Fax Forwarding is set to Print and
Forward or Forward.
Max Speed
33600*
14400
9600
4800
2400
Set the maximum speed for transmitting fax.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 160
background
Fax Cover Page
Menu item Description
Fax Cover Page
O by Default*
On by Default
Never Use
Always Use
Configure the settings for the fax cover page.
Include To field
O*
On
Include From field
O*
On
From
Include Message Field
O*
On
Message:
Include Logo
O*
On
Include Footer [x]
O*
On
Footer [x]
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Fax Log Settings
Menu item Description
Transmission Log Frequency
Always*
Never
Only for Error
Specify how often the printer creates a transmission log.
Transmission Log Action
Print
O
On*
Email
O*
On
Print or email a log for successful fax transmission or transmission error.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 161
background
Menu item Description
Receive Error Log
Print Never*
Print on Error
Print a log for faxreceive failures.
Auto Print Logs
On*
O
Print all fax activity.
Log Paper Source
Tray [x] (1*)
Specify the paper source for printing logs.
Logs Display
Remote Fax Name*
Dialed Number
Identify the sender by remote fax name or fax number.
Enable Job Log
On*
O
View a summary of all fax jobs.
Enable Call Log
On*
O
View a summary of the fax call history.
Log Output Bin
Standard Bin*
Bin [x]
Specify the output bin for printed logs.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Speaker Settings
Menu item Description
Speaker Mode
Always
O*
Always On
On until Connected
Set the fax speaker mode.
Speaker Volume
Low*
High
Adjust the fax speaker volume.
Ringer Volume
O*
On
Enable the ringer volume.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 162
background
VoIP Settings
Menu item Description
VoIP Protocol
SIP*
H.323
Set the Voice over Internet Protocol (VoIP) protocol.
STUN Server Specify the STUN server to traverse a firewall.
Force Fax Mode
O
On*
Switch VoIP gateway from analog to T.38 at the beginning of a fax call.
Force Fax Mode Delay
0–15 (7*)
Set the time delay in seconds when sending another invite of Force Fax Mode.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
SIP Settings
Menu item Description
Proxy Specify the IP address of the system that converts the phone number to an IP
address where the fax is sent.
Registrar Specify a name or IP address of the system that handles the registration of
Session Initiation Protocol (SIP) clients.
User Specify the name of the user for SIP.
Password Specify the password that is used in registering with the SIP Registrar.
Auth ID The user name that is used when registering.
Note: If the Auth ID setting is not set, the setting uses the user name of the
User field instead.
Transport For Registration
UDP*
TCP
Set the SIP transport type for registration.
Transport For Incoming Calls
UDP*
TCP
UDP And TCP
Set the SIP transport type for incoming calls.
Transport For Outgoing Calls
UDP*
TCP
Set the SIP transport type for outgoing calls.
Outbound Proxy Specify an outbound proxy to forward all SIP communication.
Contact Specify a contact name for SIP.
Realm Specify a realm name for SIP.
Note: If the Realm setting is not set, the setting uses the name of the Contact
instead.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 163
background
Menu item Description
SIP Registration Status Show the status of the SIP Registration.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
H.323 Settings
Menu item Description
Gateway Specify the H.323 gateway IP address.
Gatekeeper Specify the H.323 gatekeeper.
User Specify the user name used with the H.323 gateway.
Password Specify the password for the H.323 gateway.
Enable Fast Start
O*
On
Enable Fast Start.
Disable H.245 Tunneling
O*
On
Disable H.323 Tunneling.
Disable Gatekeeper Discovery
O
On*
Disable H.323 Gatekeeper Discovery.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
T.3 8 Settings
Menu item Description
Indicator Redundancy
0–5 (3*)
Set the number of times that a fax indicator is repeated in the T.38
communication.
Low Speed Redundancy
0–5 (3*)
Set the number of times that low speed data is repeated in the T.38
communication.
High Speed Redundancy
0–5 (1*)
Set the number of times that high-speed data is repeated in the T.38
communication.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Fax Server Setup
General Fax Settings
Menu item Description
To Fo rmat Specify a fax recipient.
Note: If you want to use the fax number, then type the number sign (#) before
a number.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 164
background
Menu item Description
Reply Address Specify a reply address for sending fax.
Subject Specify the fax subject and message.
Message
Enable analog receive
O*
On
Set the printer to receive analog faxes.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Fax Server Email Settings
Menu item Description
Use Email SMTP Server
On
O*
Use the Simple Mail Transfer Protocol (SMTP) settings for email in receiving
and sending faxes.
Note: When set to On, all other settings of the Fax Server Email Settings
menu are not shown.
Primary SMTP Gateway Type the IP address or host name of the primary SMTP server.
Primary SMTP Gateway Port
1–65535 (25*)
Enter the port number of the primary SMTP server.
Secondary SMTP Gateway Type the server IP address or host name of your secondary or backup SMTP
server.
Secondary SMTP Gateway Port
1–65535 (25*)
Enter the server port number of your secondary or backup SMTP server.
SMTP Timeout
5–30 (30*)
Set the time before the printer times out if the SMTP server does not respond.
Reply Address Specify a reply address for sending fax.
Use SSL/TLS
Disabled*
Negotiate
Required
Specify whether to send fax using an encrypted link.
Require Trusted Certicate
O
On*
Specify a trusted certificate when accessing the SMTP server.
SMTP Server Authentication
No authentication required*
Login / Plain
NTLM
CRAMMD5
DigestMD5
Kerberos 5
Set the authentication type for the SMTP server.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 165
background
Menu item Description
DeviceInitiated Email
None*
Use Device SMTP Credentials
Specify whether credentials are required for deviceinitiated email.
UserInitiated Email
None*
Use Device SMTP Credentials
Use Session User ID and
Password
Use Session Email address
and Password
Prompt user
Specify whether credentials are required for userinitiated email.
Use Active Directory Device
Credentials
O*
On
Enable user credentials and group destinations to connect to the SMTP server.
Device Userid Specify the user ID and password to connect to the SMTP server.
Device Password
Kerberos 5 REALM Specify the realm for the Kerberos 5 authentication protocol.
NTLM Domain Specify the domain name for the NTLM security protocol.
Disable "SMTP server not set
up" error
O*
On
Hide the “SMTP server not set up” error message.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Fax Server Scan Settings
Menu item Description
Image Format
TIFF (.tif)
PDF (.pdf)*
XPS (.xps)
TXT (.txt)
RTF (.rtf)
DOCX (.docx)
XLSX (.xlsx)
CSV (.csv)
Specify the file format for the scanned image.
Content Type
Te xt *
Te xt /P ho to
Photo
Graphics
Improve the output result based on the content of the original document.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 166
background
Menu item Description
Content Source
Black and White Laser
Color Laser*
Inkjet
Photo/Film
Magazine
Newspaper
Press
Other
Improve the output result based on the source of the original document.
Fax Resolution
Standard*
Fine
Super Fine
Ultra Fine
Set the fax resolution.
Sides
O*
Short Edge
Long Edge
Specify the orientation of the original document when scanning on both sides
of the document.
Darkness
1–9 (5*)
Set the darkness of the output.
Orientation
Portrait*
Landscape
Specify the orientation of text and graphics on the page.
Original Size
[List of paper sizes]
Set the paper size of the original document.
Notes:
Mixed Sizes is the U.S. factory default setting. A4 is the international
factory default setting.
This setting may vary depending on your printer model.
Use MultiPage TIFF
O
On*
Choose between single and multiplepage TIFF files.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 167
background
E-mail
Email Setup
Menu item Description
Primary SMTP Gateway Type the IP address or host name of the primary SMTP server for
sending e-mail.
Primary SMTP Gateway Port
1–65535 (25*)
Enter the port number of the primary SMTP server.
Secondary SMTP Gateway Type the server IP address or host name of your secondary or
backup SMTP server.
Secondary SMTP Gateway Port
1–65535 (25*)
Enter the server port number of your secondary or backup SMTP
server.
SMTP Timeout
5–30 seconds (30*)
Set the time before the printer times out if the SMTP server does
not respond.
Reply Address Specify a reply address in the email.
Always use SMTP default Reply Address
On
O*
Always use the default reply address in the SMTP server.
Use SSL/TLS
Disabled*
Negotiate
Required
Specify whether to send email using an encrypted link.
Require Trusted Certicate
O
On*
Require a trusted certificate when accessing the SMTP server.
SMTP Server Authentication
No authentication required*
Login / Plain
NTLM
CRAMMD5
DigestMD5
Kerberos 5
Set the authentication type for the SMTP server.
DeviceInitiated Email
None*
Use Device SMTP Credentials
Specify whether credentials are required for deviceinitiated email.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 168
background
Menu item Description
UserInitiated Email
None*
Use Device SMTP Credentials
Use Session User ID and Password
Use Session Email address and Password
Prompt user
Specify whether credentials are required for userinitiated email.
Use Active Directory Device Credentials
O*
On
Specify whether credentials are required for userinitiated email.
Device Userid Specify the user ID and password to connect to the SMTP server.
Device Password
Kerberos 5 REALM Specify the realm for the Kerberos 5 authentication protocol.
NTLM Domain Specify the domain name for the NTLM security protocol.
Disable “SMTP server not set up” error
O*
On
Hide the “SMTP server not set up” error message.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Email Defaults
Menu item Description
Subject: Specify the email subject and message.
Message:
File Name Specify the filename for the scanned document.
Format
JPEG (.jpg)
PDF (.pdf)*
TIFF (.tif)
XPS (.xps)
TXT (.txt)
RTF (.rtf)
DOCX (.docx)
XLSX (.xlsx)
CSV (.csv)
Specify the file format of the scanned document.
Global OCR Settings
Recognized Languages
Auto Rotate
(O*)
Despeckle (O*)
Auto Contrast Enhance
(O*)
Configure the settings for optical character recognition (OCR).
Note: This menu item appears only if you have purchased and installed an OCR
solution.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 169
background
Menu item Description
PDF Settings
PDF Version (1.5*)
Archival Version (A1a*)
Highly Compressed (O*)
Secure (O*)
Searchable
(O*)
Archival (PDF/A) (O*)
Configure the PDF settings of the scanned document.
Notes:
Archival Version and Archival (PDF/A) are supported only when PDF
Version is set to 1.4.
Highly Compressed appears only when a hard disk or an intelligent storage
drive (ISD) is installed.
Content Type
Te xt
Te xt /P ho to *
Photo
Graphics
Improve the output result based on the content type of the original document.
Content Source
Black and White Laser
Color Laser*
Inkjet
Photo/Film
Magazine
Newspaper
Press
Other
Improve the output result based on the content source of the original document.
Color
Black and White
Gray
Color*
Auto
Set the printer to capture file content in color or in mono.
Resolution
75 dpi
150 dpi*
200 dpi
300 dpi
400 dpi
600 dpi
Set the resolution of the scanned image.
Darkness
1–9 (5*)
Adjust the darkness of the scanned image.
Orientation
Portrait*
Landscape
Specify the orientation of the original document.
Original Size
Mixed Sizes*
Set the paper size of the original document.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 170
background
Menu item Description
Sides
O*
Short Edge
Long Edge
Specify the orientation of the original document when scanning on both sides of
the document.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Advanced Imaging
Menu item Description
Color Balance
Cyan (0*)
Magenta (0*)
Ye l l o w ( 0 * )
Adjust the color intensity for cyan, magenta, and yellow.
Color Dropout
Color Dropout (None*)
Default Red Threshold (128*)
Default Green Threshold (128*)
Default Blue Threshold (128*)
Specify which color to drop during scanning, and adjust the dropout
setting for that color.
Auto Color Detect
Color Sensitivity (5*)
Area Sensitivity (5*)
Email Bit Depth (1 bit*)
Minimum Scan Resolution (300 dpi*)
Configure the auto color detection setting.
JPEG Quality
Best for content*
5–95
Set the JPEG quality of the scanned image.
Contrast
Best for content*
0–5
Specify the contrast for the scanned image.
Background Removal
Background Detection (Contentbased*)
Level (0*)
Remove the background color or image noise from the original
document.
Notes:
Content-based removes the background color from the original
document.
Fixed removes image noise from a photo.
Mirror Image
O*
On
Create a mirror image of the original document.
Negative Image
O*
On
Create a negative image of the original document.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 171
background
Menu item Description
Shadow Detail
4 to 4 (0*)
Adjust the shadow detail in the scanned image.
Scan Edge to Edge
O*
On
Scan the original document from edge to edge.
Sharpness
1–5 (3*)
Adjust the sharpness in the scanned image.
Temp erature
4 to 4 (0*)
Generate a bluer or redder output of the original document.
Blank Pages
Blank Page Removal (Do Not Remove*)
Blank Page Sensitivity (5*)
Set the sensitivity of scans in relation to blank pages in the original
document.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Admin Controls
Menu item Description
Max Email Size
0–65535 (0*)
Set the allowable file size for each email.
Size Error Message Specify an error message that the printer sends when an email exceeds
its allowable file size.
Note: You can type up to 1024 characters.
Limit Destinations Limit sending of email only to the specified list of domain name.
Note: Use a comma to separate each domain.
Send Me a Copy
Never appears*
On by Default
O by Default
Always On
Send a copy of the email to yourself.
Allow self emails only
O*
On
Set the printer to send emails to yourself only.
Use cc:/bcc:
O*
On
Enable carbon copy and blind carbon copy in email.
Use MultiPage TIFF
O
On*
Enable scanning of multiple TIFF images in one TIFF file.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 172
background
Menu item Description
TIFF Compression
JPEG
LZW*
Specify the compression type for TIFF files.
Text Defau lt
5–95 (75*)
Set the text quality in the content being scanned.
Text/Photo Def ault
5–95 (75*)
Set the text and photo quality in the content being scanned.
Photo Default
5–95 (50*)
Set the photo quality of the content being scanned.
Adjust ADF Skew
O
On*
Set the printer to adjust the skewed images from documents that are
scanned from the ADF.
Transmission Log
Print log*
Do Not Print Log
Print Only For Error
Print a transmission log for email scans.
Log Paper Source
Tray [x] (1*)
Multipurpose Feeder
Specify the paper source for printing email logs.
Custom Job Scanning
O*
On
Set the printer to scan the first set of original documents using the
specified settings, and then scan the next set with the same or dierent
settings.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is
installed.
Scan Preview
O*
On
Show a scan preview of the original document.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is
installed.
Allow Save as Shortcut
O
On*
Save an email address as a shortcut.
Email Images Sent As
Attachment*
Web Link
Specify how to send the images that are included in the email.
Reset E-mail Information After Sending
O
On*
Reset the To, Subject, Message, and Filename fields to their default
values after sending an email.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 173
background
Web Link Setup
Menu item Description
Server Specify the credentials of the server that is hosting the images that are included
in the e-mail.
Login
Password
Path
File Name
Web Link
FTP
FTP Defaults
Menu item Description
Format
JPEG (.jpg)
PDF (.pdf)*
TIFF (.tif)
XPS (.xps)
TXT (.txt)
RTF (.rtf)
DOCX (.docx)
XLSX (.xlsx)
CSV (.csv)
Specify the file format for the scanned image.
Global OCR Settings
Recognized Languages
Auto Rotate (O*)
Despeckle (O*)
Auto Contrast Enhance (O*)
Configure the settings for optical character recognition (OCR).
Note: This menu item appears only if you have purchased and installed an OCR
solution.
PDF Settings
PDF Version (1.5*)
Archival Version (A1a*)
Highly Compressed (O*)
Secure
(O*)
Searchable (O*)
Archival (PDF/A) (O*)
Configure the PDF settings for the scanned image.
Notes:
Archival Version and Archival (PDF/A) are supported only when PDF
Version is set to 1.4.
Highly Compressed appears only when a hard disk or an intelligent storage
drive (ISD) is installed.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 174
background
Menu item Description
Content Type
Te xt
Te xt /P ho to *
Graphics
Photo
Improve the output result based on the content type of the original document.
Content Source
Black and White Laser
Color Laser*
Inkjet
Photo/Film
Magazine
Newspaper
Press
Other
Improve the output result based on the content source of the original document.
Color
Black and White
Gray
Color*
Auto
Set the printer to capture file content in color or in mono.
Resolution
75 dpi
150 dpi*
200 dpi
300 dpi
400 dpi
600 dpi
Set the resolution of the scanned image.
Darkness
1–9 (5*)
Adjust the darkness of the scanned image.
Orientation
Portrait*
Landscape
Specify the orientation of the original document.
Original Size
Mixed Sizes*
Set the paper size of the original document.
Sides
O*
Long Edge
Short Edge
Specify the orientation when scanning on both sides of the document.
File Name Specify the file name of the scanned image.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 175
background
Advanced Imaging
Menu item Description
Color Balance
Cyan (0*)
Magenta (0*)
Ye l l o w ( 0 * )
Adjust the color intensity for cyan, magenta, and yellow.
Color Dropout
Color Dropout (None*)
Default Red Threshold (128*)
Default Green Threshold (128*)
Default Blue Threshold (128*)
Specify which color to drop during scanning, and adjust the dropout
setting for that color.
Auto Color Detect
Color Sensitivity (5*)
Area Sensitivity (5*)
FTP Bit Depth (1 bit*)
Minimum Scan Resolution (300 dpi*)
Configure the auto color detection setting.
JPEG Quality
Best for content*
5–95
Set the JPEG quality of the scanned image.
Contrast
Best for content*
0
1
2
3
4
5
Specify the contrast for the scanned image.
Background Removal
Background Detection (Contentbased*)
Level (0*)
Remove the background color or image noise from the original
document.
Notes:
Content-based removes the background color from the original
document .
Fixed removes image noise from a photo.
Mirror Image
O*
On
Create a mirror image of the original document.
Negative Image
O*
On
Create a negative image of the original document.
Shadow Detail
4 to 4 (0*)
Adjust the shadow detail in the scanned image.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 176
background
Menu item Description
Scan Edge to Edge
O*
On
Allow edgetoedge scanning of the original document.
Sharpness
1–5 (3*)
Adjust the sharpness in the scanned image.
Temp erature
4 to 4 (0*)
Generate a bluer or redder output of the original document.
Blank Pages
Blank Page Removal (Do Not Remove*)
Blank Page Sensitivity (5*)
Set the sensitivity of scans in relation to blank pages in the original
document.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Admin Controls
Menu item Description
Text Defau lt
5–95 (75*)
Set the quality of text on the scanned image.
Text/Photo Def ault
5–95 (75*)
Set the quality of text and photo on the scanned image.
Photo Default
5–95 (50*)
Set the quality of photo on the scanned image.
Use MultiPage TIFF
On*
O
Enable scanning of multiple TIFF images in one TIFF file.
TIFF Compression
LZW*
JPEG
Specify the compression type for TIFF files.
Transmission Log
Print Log*
Do Not Print Log
Print Only For Error
Print a transmission log for FTP scans.
Log Paper Source
Tray [x] (1*)
Multipurpose Feeder
Specify the paper source for printing FTP logs.
Custom Job Scanning
O*
On
Set the printer to scan the first set of original documents using the specified
settings, and then scan the next set with the same or dierent settings.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is installed.
Scan Preview
O*
On
Show a preview of the original document.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is installed.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 177
background
Menu item Description
Allow Save as Shortcut
O
On*
Save an FTP address as a shortcut.
Adjust ADF Skew
O*
On
Set the printer to adjust the skewed images from documents that are scanned
from the ADF.
Use Passive FTP
O*
On
Let the FTP server specify the data port that the printer connects to.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
USB Drive
Flash Drive Scan
Menu item Description
Format
JPEG (.jpg)
PDF (.pdf)*
TIFF (.tif)
XPS (.xps)
TXT (.txt)
RTF (.rtf)
DOCX (.docx)
XLSX (.xlsx)
CSV (.csv)
Specify the file format for the scanned image.
Global OCR Settings
Recognized Languages
Auto Rotate
(O*)
Despeckle (O*)
Auto Contrast Enhance
(O*)
Configure the settings for optical character recognition (OCR).
Note: This menu item appears only if you have purchased and installed an OCR
solution.
PDF Settings
PDF Version (1.5*)
Archival Version (A1a*)
Highly Compressed (O*)
Secure
(O*)
Searchable (O*)
Archival (PDF/A) (O*)
Configure the PDF settings of the scanned image.
Notes:
Archival Version and Archival (PDF/A) are supported only when PDF
Version is set to 1.4.
Highly Compressed appears only when a hard disk or an intelligent storage
drive (ISD) is installed.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 178
background
Menu item Description
Content Type
Te xt
Te xt /P ho to *
Graphics
Photo
Improve the output result based on the content type of the original document.
Content Source
Black and White Laser
Color Laser*
Inkjet
Photo/Film
Magazine
Newspaper
Press
Other
Improve the output result based on the content source of the original document.
Color
Black and White
Gray
Color*
Auto
Set the printer to capture file content in color or in mono.
Resolution
75 dpi
150 dpi*
200 dpi
300 dpi
400 dpi
600 dpi
Set the resolution of the scanned image.
Darkness
1–9 (5*)
Adjust the darkness of the scanned image.
Orientation
Portrait*
Landscape
Specify the orientation of the original document.
Original Size
Mixed Sizes*
Set the paper size of the original document.
Sides
O*
Long edge
Short edge
Specify the orientation of the original document when scanning on both sides of
the document.
File Name Specify the file name of the scanned image.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 179
background
Advanced Imaging
Menu item Description
Color Balance
Cyan (0*)
Magenta (0*)
Ye l l o w ( 0 * )
Adjust the color intensity for cyan, magenta, and yellow.
Color Dropout
Color Dropout (None*)
Default Red Threshold (128*)
Default Green Threshold (128*)
Default Blue Threshold (128*)
Specify which color to drop during scanning, and adjust the dropout
setting for that color.
Auto Color Detect
Color Sensitivity (5*)
Area Sensitivity (5*)
Scan Bit Depth (1 bit*)
Minimum Scan Resolution (300 dpi*)
Configure the auto color detection setting.
JPEG Quality
Best for content*
5–95
Set the JPEG quality of the scanned image.
Contrast
Best for content*
0–5
Specify the contrast for the scanned image.
Background Removal
Background Detection (Contentbased*)
Level (0*)
Remove the background color or image noise from the original
document.
Notes:
Content-based removes the background color from the original
document.
Fixed removes image noise from a photo.
Mirror Image
O*
On
Create a mirror image of the original document.
Negative Image
O*
On
Create a negative image of the original document.
Shadow Detail
4 to 4 (0*)
Adjust the shadow detail in the scanned image.
Scan Edge to Edge
O*
On
Scan the original document from edge to edge.
Sharpness
1–5 (3*)
Adjust the sharpness in the scanned image.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 180
background
Menu item Description
Temp erature
4 to 4 (0*)
Generate a bluer or redder output of the original document.
Blank Pages
Blank Page Removal (Do Not Remove*)
Blank Page Sensitivity (5*)
Set the sensitivity of scans in relation to blank pages in the original
document.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Admin Controls
Menu item Description
Text Defau lt
5–95 (75*)
Set the quality of text on the scanned image.
Text/Photo Def ault
5–95 (75*)
Set the quality of text and photo on the scanned image.
Photo Default
5–95 (50*)
Set the quality of a photo on the scanned image.
Use MultiPage TIFF
O
On*
Enable scanning of multiple TIFF images in one TIFF file.
TIFF Compression
LZW*
JPEG
Specify the compression type for TIFF files.
Custom Job Scanning
O*
On
Set the printer to scan the first set of original documents using the specified
settings, and then scan the next set with the same or dierent settings.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is installed.
Scan Preview
O*
On
Show a scan preview of the original document.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is installed.
Adjust ADF Skew
O*
On
Set the printer to adjust the skewed images from documents that are scanned
from the ADF.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Flash Drive Print
Menu item Description
Number of Copies
1–9999 (1*)
Set the number of copies.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 181
background
Menu item Description
Paper Source
Tray [x] (1*)
Multipurpose Feeder
Manual Paper
Manual Envelope
Set the paper source for the print job.
Color
O
On*
Print a flash drive file in color.
Collate
O [1,1,1,2,2,2]
On [1,2,1,2,1,2]*
Keep the pages of a print job stacked in sequence, particularly when printing multiple
copies of the job.
Sides
1Sided*
2Sided
Specify whether to print on one side or both sides of the paper.
Flip Style
Long Edge*
Short Edge
Determine which side of the paper is bound when performing twosided printing.
Pages per Side
O*
2 pages per side
3 pages per side
4 pages per side
6 pages per side
9 pages per side
12 pages per side
16 pages per side
Print multiple page images on one side of a sheet of paper.
Pages per Side Ordering
Horizontal*
Reverse Horizontal
Reverse Vertical
Vertical
Specify the positioning of multiple page images when using Pages per Side menu.
Pages per Side Orientation
Auto*
Landscape
Portrait
Specify the orientation of multiple page images when using Pages per Side menu.
Pages per Side Border
None*
Solid
Print a border around each page image when using Pages per Side menu.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 182
background
Menu item Description
Separator Sheets
O*
Between Copies
Between Jobs
Between Pages
Insert blank separator sheets when printing.
Separator Sheet Source
Tray [x] (1*)
Multipurpose Feeder
Specify the paper source for the separator sheet.
Blank Pages
Do Not Print*
Print
Print blank pages in a print job.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Network/Ports
Network Overview
Menu item Description
Active Adapter
Auto*
Standard Network
Wireless
Specify the type of the network connection.
Note: Wireless is available only in printers connected to a wireless network.
Network Status Show the connectivity status of the printer network.
Display Network Status on
Printer
O
On*
Show the network status on the display.
Speed, Duplex Show the speed of the currently active network card.
IPv4 Show the IPv4 address.
All IPv6 Addresses Show all IPv6 addresses.
Reset Print Server Reset all active network connections to the printer.
Note: This setting removes all network
configuration
settings.
Network Job Timeout
O
On* (90 seconds)
Set the time before the printer cancels a network print job.
Banner Page
O*
On
Print a banner page.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 183
background
Menu item Description
Scan to PC Port Range Specify a valid port range for printers that are behind a port blocking firewall.
Enable Network Connections
O
On*
Enable the printer to connect to a network.
Enable LLDP
O*
On
Enable Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) in the printer.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Wireless
Note: This menu is available only in printers connected to a WiFi network or printers that have a wireless
network adapter.
Menu item Description
Setup Using Mobile App Configure the WiFi connection using Lexmark Mobile Assistant.
Setup On Printer Panel
Choose Network
Add WiFi Network
Network Name
Network Mode
Infrastructure
Wireless Security Mode
Disabled*
WPA2/WPA - Personal
WPA2 - Personal
WPA2/WPA3 Personal
WPA3 Personal
802.1x - RADIUS
Configure the WiFi connection using the control panel.
Note: This menu item appears as Wireless Connection Setup in the
Embedded Web Server.
WiFi Protected Setup
Start Push Button Method
Start PIN Method
Establish a WiFi network and enable network security.
Notes:
Start Push Button Method connects the printer to a WiFi
network when buttons on both the printer and the access point
(wireless router) are pressed within a given time.
Start PIN Method connects the printer to a WiFi network when
a PIN on the printer is entered into the wireless settings of the
access point.
Compatibility
802.11b/g/n (2.4GHz)*
802.11a/b/g/n/ac (2.4GHz/5GHz)
802.11a/n/ac (5GHz)
Specify the standard for the WiFi network.
Note: 802.11a/b/g/n/ac (2.4GHz/5GHz) and 802.11a/n/ac (5GHz) only
appear when a WiFi option is installed.
Use printer menus 184
background
Menu item Description
Wireless Security Mode
Disabled*
WPA2/WPA-Personal
WPA2-Personal
WPA2/WPA3 Personal
WPA3 Personal
802.1x - RADIUS
Set the security mode for connecting the printer to WiFi devices.
WPA2/WPA Personal
AES*
Enable WiFi security through Wi-Fi Protected Access (WPA).
Note: This menu item appears only when the Wireless Security
Mode is set to WPA2/WPA-Personal.
Set PSK Set the password for secure WiFi connection.
WPA2-Personal
AES*
Enable WiFi security through WPA2.
Note: This menu item appears only when the Wireless Security
Mode is set to WPA2-Personal.
802.1x Encryption Mode
WPA+
WPA2*
WPA2 + PMF*
Enable WiFi security through 802.1x standard.
Note: This menu item appears only when the Wireless Security
Mode is set to 802.1x - RADIUS.
IPv4
Enable DHCP
On*
O
Set Static IP Address
IP Address
Netmask
Gateway
Enable and configure IPv4 settings in the printer.
IPv6
Enable IPv6
On*
O
Enable DHCPv6
On
O*
Stateless Address
Autoconfiguration
On*
O
DNS Server Address
Manually Assigned IPv6 Address
Manually Assigned IPv6 Router
Address Prefix
All IPv6 Addresses
All IPv6 Router Addresses
Enable and configure IPv6 settings in the printer.
Use printer menus 185
background
Menu item Description
Network Address
UAA
LAA
View the network addresses.
PCL SmartSwitch
On*
O
Set the printer to switch automatically to PCL emulation when a print
job requires it, regardless of the default printer language.
Note: If PCL SmartSwitch is
o,
then the printer does not examine
incoming data and uses the default printer language specified in
the Setup menu.
PS SmartSwitch
On*
O
Set the printer to switch automatically to PS emulation when a print
job requires it, regardless of the default printer language.
Note: If PS SmartSwitch is o, then the printer does not examine
incoming data and uses the default printer language specified in
the Setup menu.
Job Buering
On
O*
Temporarily store print jobs in the hard disk or intelligent storage
drive (ISD) before printing.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is
installed.
Mac Binary PS
Auto*
On
O
Set the printer to process Macintosh binary PostScript print jobs.
Notes:
On processes raw binary PostScript print jobs.
O
filters
print jobs using the standard protocol.
WiFi Direct
Note: This menu is available only in printers connected to a WiFi network or printers that have a wireless
network adapter.
Menu item Description
Enable WiFi Direct
On
O*
Set the printer to connect directly to Wi-Fi devices.
WiFi Direct Name Specify the name of the WiFi Direct network.
WiFi Direct Password Set the password to authenticate and validate users on a WiFi connection.
Show Password on Setup Page
O
On*
Show the WiFi Direct Password on the Network Setup Page.
Preferred Channel Number
1–11
Auto*
Set the preferred channel of the WiFi network.
Group Owner IP Address Specify the IP address of the group owner.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 186
background
Menu item Description
AutoAccept Push Button
Requests
O*
On
Accept requests to connect to the network automatically.
Note: Accepting clients automatically is not secured.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Mobile Services Management
Menu item Description
Enable IPP Print
On*
O
Allow printing from mobile devices using Internet Printing Protocol (IPP).
Enable IPP Fax
On*
O
Allow sending faxes using Internet Printing Protocol (IPP).
Enable IPP Over USB
On*
O
Allow print or scan jobs using USB connection.
Enable Scan
On*
O
Allow scanning using eSCL protocol.
Enable Mopria Discovery
On*
O
Allow the printer to be detected by Mopriaenabled devices.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Ethernet
Menu item Description
Network Speed Show the speed of the active network adapter.
IPv4
Enable DHCP (On*)
Set Static IP Address
Configure the IPv4 settings.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 187
background
Menu item Description
IPv6
Enable IPv6 (On*)
Enable DHCPv6
(O*)
Stateless Address Autoconfiguration
(On*)
DNS Server Address
Manually Assigned IPv6 Address
Manually Assigned IPv6 Router
Address Prefix (64*)
All IPv6 Addresses
All IPv6 Router Addresses
Configure the IPv6 settings.
Network Address
UAA
LAA
Specify the network address.
PCL SmartSwitch
O
On*
Set the printer to switch automatically to PCL emulation when a print
job requires it, regardless of the default printer language.
Note: When this setting is disabled, the printer does not examine
incoming data and uses the default printer language specified in
the Setup menu.
PS SmartSwitch
O
On*
Set the printer to switch automatically to PostScript emulation when
a print job requires it, regardless of the default printer language.
Note: When this setting is disabled, the printer does not examine
incoming data and uses the default printer language specified in
the Setup menu.
Job Buering
O*
On
Temporarily store print jobs in the hard disk or intelligent storage
drive (ISD) before printing.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is
installed.
Mac Binary PS
Auto*
On
O
Set the printer to process Macintosh binary PostScript print jobs.
Notes:
Auto processes print jobs from computers using either
Windows or Macintosh operating systems.
O
filters
PostScript print jobs using the standard protocol.
Energy Ecient Ethernet
On
O
Auto*
Reduce power consumption when the printer does not receive data
from the Ethernet network.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
TCP/IP
Note: This menu appears only in network printers or printers attached to print servers.
Use printer menus 188
background
Menu item Description
Set Hostname Set the current TCP/IP host name.
Domain Name Set the domain name.
Allow DHCP/BOOTP to update
NTP server
On*
O
Allow the DHCP and BOOTP clients to update the NTP settings of the printer.
Zero Configuration Name Specify a service name for the zero configuration network.
Enable Auto IP
O
On*
Assign an IP address automatically.
DNS Server Address Specify the current Domain Name System (DNS) server address.
Backup DNS Address Specify the backup DNS server addresses.
Backup DNS Address 2
Backup DNS Address 3
Domain Search Order Specify a list of domain names to locate the printer and its resources that reside
in dierent domains on the network.
Enable DDNS
O*
On
Update the Dynamic DNS settings.
DDNS TTL Specify the current DDNS settings.
Default TTL
DDNS Refresh Time
Enable mDNS
O
On*
Update the multicast DNS settings.
WINS Server Address Specify a server address for Windows Internet Name Service (WINS).
Enable BOOTP
O*
On
Allow the BOOTP to assign a printer IP address.
Restricted Server List Specify the IP addresses that are allowed to communicate with the printer over
TCP/IP.
Notes:
Use a comma to separate each IP address.
You can add up to 50 IP addresses.
This menu item is available only in some printer models.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 189
background
Menu item Description
Restricted Server List Options
Block All Ports*
Block Printing Only
Block Printing and HTTP Only
Specify the access option for IP addresses that are not in the list.
Note: This menu item is available only in some printer models.
MTU
256–1500 Ethernet (1500*)
Specify a maximum transmission unit (MTU) parameter for the TCP connections.
Raw Print Port
1–65535 (9100*)
Specify a raw port number for printers connected on a network.
Outbound Trac Maximum
Speed
O*
On
Set the maximum transfer rate of the printer.
Note: When enabled, the option for this setting is 100–1000000
Kilobits/second.
TLS Support
Enable TLSv1.0 (O)
Enable TLSv1.1 (O*)
Enable TLSv1.2 (On*)
Enable the Transport Layer Security protocol.
SSL Cipher List Specify the cipher algorithms to use for the SSL or the TLS connections.
TLSv1.3 SSL Cipher List Specify the specific cipher string to use for TLS v1.3.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
SNMP
Note: This menu appears only in network printers or printers that are attached to print servers.
Menu item Description
SNMP Versions 1 and 2c
Enabled
O
On*
Allow SNMP Set
O
On*
Enable PPM MIB
O
On*
SNMP Community
Configure Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) versions 1
and 2c to install print drivers and applications.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 190
background
Menu item Description
SNMP Version 3
Enabled
O
On*
Context Name
Set Read/Write Credentials
User Name
Authentication Password
Privacy Password
Set Readonly Credentials
User Name
Authentication Password
Privacy Password
Authentication Hash
MD5
SHA1*
Minimum Authentication Level
No Authentication, No Privacy
Authentication, No Privacy
Authentication, Privacy*
Privacy Algorithm
DES
AES128*
Configure SNMP version 3 to install and update the printer security.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
IPSec
Note: This menu appears only in network printers or printers that are attached to print servers.
Menu item Description
Enable IPSec
O*
On
Enable Internet Protocol Security (IPSec).
Base Configuration
Default*
Compatibility
Secure
Set the IPSec base configuration.
Note: This menu item appears only when Enable IPSec is set to
On.
DH (DieHellman) Group Proposal
modp2048 (14)*
modp3072 (15)
modp4096 (16)
modp6144 (17)
Set the IPSec base configuration.
Note: This menu item appears only when Base
Configuration
is set
to Compatibility.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 191
background
Menu item Description
Proposed Encryption Method
3DES
AES*
Set the encryption method.
Note: This menu item appears only when Base
Configuration
is set
to Compatibility.
Proposed Authentication Method
SHA1
SHA256*
SHA512
Set the authentication method.
Note: This menu item appears only when Base Configuration is set
to Compatibility.
IKE SA Lifetime (Hours)
1
2
4
8
24*
Specify the IKE SA expiry period.
Note: This menu item appears only when Base Configuration is set
to Secure.
IPSec SA Lifetime (Hours)
1
2
4
8*
24
Specify the IPSec SA expiry period.
Note: This menu item appears only when Base
Configuration
is set
to Secure.
IPSec Device Certificate Specify an IPSec certificate.
Note: This menu item appears only when Enable IPSec is set to
On.
PreShared Key Authenticated
Connections
Host [x]
Configure the authenticated connections of the printer.
Note: These menu items appear only when Enable IPSec is set to
On.
Certificate Authenticated Connections
Host [x] Address[/subnet]
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
802.1x
Note: This menu appears only in network printers or printers that are attached to print servers.
Menu item Description
Active
O*
On
Let the printer join networks that require authentication before
allowing access.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 192
background
Menu item Description
802.1x Authentication
Device Login Name
Device Login Password
Validate Serve Certificate (On*)
Enable Event Logging (O*)
802.1x Device
Certificate
Configure the settings for authenticating the 802.1x connection.
Authentication Mechanisms
EAP MD5 (On*)
EAP - MSCHAPv2 (On*)
LEAP (On*)
PEAP (On*)
EAP - TLS (On*)
EAP - TTLS (On*)
TTLS Authentication Method
(MSCHAPv2*)
Configure the allowed authentication mechanisms for the 802.1x
connection.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
LPD Configuration
Note: This menu appears only in network printers or printers that are attached to print servers.
Menu item Description
LPD Timeout
0–65535 seconds (90*)
Set the timeout value to stop the Line Printer Daemon (LPD) server
from waiting indefinitely for hung or invalid print jobs.
LPD Banner Page
O*
On
Print a banner page for all LPD print jobs.
Note: A banner page is the first page of a print job used as a
separator of print jobs and to identify the originator of the print job
request.
LPD Trailer Page
O*
On
Print a trailer page for all LPD print jobs.
Note: A trailer page is the last page of a print job.
LPD Carriage Return Conversion
O*
On
Enable carriage return conversion.
Note: Carriage return is a mechanism that commands the printer to
move the position of the cursor to the first position on the same
line.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 193
background
HTTP/FTP Settings
Menu item Description
Proxy
HTPP Proxy IP Address
HTTP Default IP Port
FTP Proxy IP Address
FTP Default IP Port
Authentication
User Name
Password
Local Domains
Configure the HTTP and FTP server settings.
Other Settings
Enable HTTP Server (On*)
Access the Embedded Web Server to monitor and manage the printer.
Other Settings
Enable HTPPS (On*)
Enable Hypertext Transfer Protocol Secure (HTTPS) to encrypt data
transferring to and from the print server.
Other Settings
Force HTTPS Connections (O*)
Force the printer to use HTTPS connections.
Other Settings
Enable FTP/TFTP (On*)
Send files using FTP/TFTP.
Other Settings
HTTPS Device
Certificate
(default*)
View the HTTP device certificate used on the printer.
Other Settings
Timeout for HTTP/FTP Requests (30*)
Specify the amount of time before the server connection stops.
Other Settings
Retries for HTTP/FTP Requests (3*)
Set the number of retries to connect to the HTTP/FTP server.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
ThinPrint
Menu item Description
Enable ThinPrint
O*
On
Print using ThinPrint.
Port Number
4000–4999 (4000*)
Set the port number for the ThinPrint server.
Bandwidth (bits/sec)
100–1000000 (0*)
Set the speed to transmit data in a ThinPrint environment.
Packet Size (kbytes)
0–64000 (0*)
Set the packet size for data transmission.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 194
background
USB
Menu item Description
PCL SmartSwitch
O
On*
Set the printer to switch to PCL emulation when a print job received through a USB port requires
it, regardless of the default printer language.
Note: When this setting is disabled, the printer does not examine incoming data and uses the
default printer language specified in the Setup menu.
PS SmartSwitch
O
On*
Set the printer to switch to PostScript emulation when a print job received through a USB port
requires it, regardless of the default printer language.
Note: When this setting is disabled, the printer does not examine incoming data and uses the
default printer language specified in the Setup menu.
Job Buering
O*
On
Temporarily store print jobs in the hard disk or intelligent storage drive (ISD) before printing.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is installed.
Mac Binary PS
Auto*
On
O
Set the printer to process Macintosh binary PostScript print jobs.
Notes:
Auto processes print jobs from computers using either Windows or Macintosh operating
systems.
O
filters
PostScript print jobs using the standard protocol.
Enable USB Port
O
On*
Enable the front USB drive port.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Restrict external network access
Menu item Description
Restrict external network
access
O*
On
Restrict access to network sites.
External network address Specify the network addresses with restricted access.
Email address for notification Specify an email address to send a notification of logged events.
Ping frequency
1–300 (10*)
Specify the network query interval in seconds.
Subject Specify the subject and message of the notification email.
Message
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 195
background
Security
Login Methods
Manage Permissions
Menu item Description
Function Access
Access Address Book in Apps
Modify Address Book
Manage Shortcuts
Create Profiles
Manage Bookmarks
Flash Drive Print
Flash Drive Color Printing
Flash Drive Scan
Copy Function
Copy Color Printing
Color Dropout
Email Function
Fax Function
FTP Function
Release Held Faxes
Held Jobs Access
Use Profiles
Cancel Jobs at the Device
Change Language
Internet Printing Protocol (IPP)
Initiate Scans Remotely
B/W Print
Color Print
Network Folder Scan
Hard Disk Print
Hard Disk Color Print
Hard Disk Scan
Control access to the printer functions.
Note: Some menu items appear only when a hard disk or an intelligent
storage drive is installed.
Administrative Menus
Security Menu
Network/Ports Menu
Paper Menu
Reports Menu
Function
Configuration
Menus
Supplies Menu
Option Card Menu
SE Menu
Device Menu
Control access to the printer menu settings.
Use printer menus 196
background
Menu item Description
Device Management
Remote Management
Firmware Updates
Apps Configuration
Operator Panel Lock
Embedded Web Server Access
Import / Export All Settings
Out of Service Erase
Cloud Services Enrollment
Control access to the printer management options.
Apps
New Apps
Slideshow
Change Wallpaper
Screen Saver
Card Copy
Scan Center
Scan Center Custom [x]
Control access to printer applications.
Local Accounts
Menu item Description
Manage Groups/Permissions
Add Group
Import Access Controls
Function Access
Administrative Menus
Device Management
Apps
All Users
Import Access Controls
Function Access
Administrative Menus
Device Management
Apps
Admin
Control group or user access to the printer functions, applications, and security
settings.
Use printer menus 197
background
Menu item Description
Add User
User Name/Password
User Name
Password
PIN
Create local accounts to manage access to the printer functions.
User Name/Password Accounts
Add User
User Name Accounts
Add User
Password Accounts
Add User
PIN Accounts
Add User
Default Login Methods
Note: This menu appears only when you
configure
the settings in the Local Accounts menu.
Menu item Description
Control Panel
User Name/Password
User Name
Password
PIN
Specify the default login method to access the control panel.
Browser
User Name/Password
User Name
Password
PIN
Specify the default login method to access the browser.
Schedule USB Devices
Menu item Description
Schedules
Add New Schedule
Schedule access to the front USB port.
Use printer menus 198
background
Security Audit Log
Menu item Description
Enable Audit
O*
On
Record the events in the secure audit log and remote syslog.
Enable Remote Syslog
O*
On
Send audit logs to a remote server.
Remote Syslog Server Specify the remote syslog server.
Remote Syslog Port
1–65535 (514*)
Specify the remote syslog port.
Remote Syslog Method
Normal UDP*
Stunnel
Specify a syslog method to transmit logged events to a remote server.
Remote Syslog Facility
0 Kernel Messages
1 UserLevel Messages
2 Mail System
3 System Daemons
4 Security/Authorization
Messages*
5 Messages Generated
Internally by Syslogs
6 Line Printer Subsystem
7 Network News Subsystem
8 UUCP Subsystem
9 Clock Daemon
10 Security/Authorization
Messages
11 FTP Daemon
12 NTP Subsystem
13 Log Audit
14 Log Alert
15 Clock Daemon
16 Local Use 0 (local0)
17 Local Use 1 (local1)
18 Local Use 2 (local2)
19 Local Use 3 (local3)
20 Local Use 4 (local4)
21 Local Use 5 (local5)
22 Local Use 6 (local6)
23 Local Use 7 (local7)
Specify a facility code that the printer uses when sending log events to a remote
server.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 199
background
Menu item Description
Severity of Events to Log
0 Emergency
1 Alert
2 Critical
3 Error
4 Warning*
5 Notice
6 Informational
7 Debug
Specify the priority level cuto for logging messages and events.
Remote Syslog NonLogged
Events
O*
On
Send all events, regardless of severity level, to the remote server.
Admin’s Email Address Send email notification of logged events to the administrator.
Email Log Cleared Alert
O*
On
Send email notification to the administrator when a log entry is deleted.
Email Log Wrapped Alert
O*
On
Send email notification to the administrator when the log becomes full and
begins to overwrite the oldest entries.
Log Full Behavior
Wrap Over Oldest Entries*
Email Log Then Delete All
Entries
Resolve log storage issues when the log fills its allotted memory.
Email % Full Alert
O*
On
Send email notification to the administrator when the log fills its allotted
memory.
% Full Alert Level
1–99 (90*)
Email Log Exported Alert
O*
On
Send email notification to the administrator when a log is exported.
Email Log Settings Changed
Alert
O*
On
Send email notification to the administrator when Enable Audit is set.
Log Line Endings
LF (\n)*
CR (\r)
CRLF (\r\n)
Specify how the log file terminates the end of each line.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 200
background
Menu item Description
Digitally Sign Exports
O*
On
Add a digital signature to each exported log file.
Clear Log Delete all audit logs.
Export Log
Syslog (RFC 5424)
Syslog (RFC 3164)
CSV
Export a security log to a flash drive.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Login Restrictions
Menu item Description
Login failures
1–10 (3*)
Specify the number of failed login attempts before the user gets locked out.
Failure time frame
1–60 minutes (5*)
Specify the time frame between failed login attempts before the user gets locked out.
Lockout time
1–60 minutes (5*)
Specify the lockout duration.
Web Login Timeout
1–120 minutes (10*)
Specify the delay for a remote login before the user is logged o automatically.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Confidential Print Setup
Menu item Description
Max Invalid PIN
2–10
Set the limit for entering an invalid PIN.
Note: When the limit is reached, the print jobs for that user name are deleted.
Confidential Job Expiration
O*
1 Hour
4 Hours
24 Hours
1 Week
Set an individual expiration time for each held job before it is automatically deleted
from the hard disk or intelligent storage drive.
Note: A held job is either
Confidential,
Repeat, Reserve, or Verify.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 201
background
Menu item Description
Repeat Job Expiration
O*
1 Hour
4 Hours
24 Hours
1 Week
Set the expiration time for a print job that you want to repeat.
Verify Job Expiration
O*
1 Hour
4 Hours
24 Hours
1 Week
Set the expiration time for printing a copy of a job for you to check its quality before
printing the remaining copies.
Reserve Job Expiration
O*
1 Hour
4 Hours
24 Hours
1 Week
Set the expiration time for jobs that you want to store in the printer for printing later.
Require All Jobs to be Held
O*
On
Set the printer to hold all print jobs.
Keep duplicate documents
O*
On
Set the printer to keep all documents with the same file name.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Disk Encryption
Note: This menu appears only when a hard disk or an intelligent storage drive is installed.
Menu item Description
Status
Enabled
Encryption happens automatically when a storage drive is installed.
Erase Temporary Data Files
Menu item Description
Stored in onboard memory
O*
On
Delete all files stored on the printer memory.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 202
background
Menu item Description
Stored on hard disk
1 Pass Erase*
3 Pass Erase
7 Pass Erase
Delete all files stored on the printer hard disk.
Note: This menu item appears only when a printer hard disk is installed.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Solutions LDAP Settings
Menu item Description
Follow LDAP Referrals
O*
On
Search the dierent servers in the domain for the logged-in user account.
LDAP Certificate Verification
Ye s
No*
Enable verification of LDAP certificates.
Miscellaneous
Menu item Description
Protected Features
Show*
Hide
Show all the features that Function Access Control (FAC) protects regardless
of the security permission that the user has.
Note: Hide displays only FACprotected features that the user has access.
Print Permission
O*
On
Let the user log in before printing.
Default Print Permission Login
User Name/Password*
User Name
Set the default login for Print Permission.
Security Reset Jumper
Enable “Guest” access*
No
Eect
Specify user access to the printer.
Notes:
Enable “Guest” access provides anyone access to all aspects of the
printer.
No Eect may make access to the printer impossible when the required
security information is unavailable.
Reset Device Modes
Allow with FAC
Allow*
Don’t allow
Specify user access to the Out of Service Erase menu.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 203
background
Menu item Description
Use Intelligent Storage Drive for
User Data
O
On*
Enable intelligent storage drive to store user data.
Minimum Password Length
0–32 (0*)
Specify the password length.
Enable Password/PIN Reveal
O*
On
Show the password or personal identification number.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Cloud Services
Cloud Services Enrollment
Menu item Description
View More Information View additional information on the usage of Lexmark Cloud
Services.
Enable communication with Lexmark Cloud
Services
O*
On
Enable the printer to communicate with Lexmark Cloud Services.
View Current Status View the connection status between the printer and Lexmark
Cloud Services.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Reports
Menu Settings Page
Menu item Description
Menu Settings Page Print a report that contains the printer menus.
Device
Device
Menu item Description
Device Information Print a report that contains information about the printer.
Use printer menus 204
background
Menu item Description
Device Statistics Print a report about printer usage and supply status.
Profiles List Print a list of profiles that are stored in the printer.
Asset Report Print a diagnostic tool for print problems.
Note: To avoid clipping the content, print the report on letter or A4size
paper.
Print
Menu item Description
Print Fonts
PCL Fonts
PS Fonts
Print samples and information about the fonts that are available in each printer
language.
Print Demo
Demo Page
Print a page that shows the printer capabilities and supported solutions.
Print Directory Print the resources that are stored in the flash drive, hard disk, or intelligent
storage drive (ISD).
Note: This menu item appears only when a ash drive, a hard disk, or an ISD
is installed.
Shortcuts
Menu item Description
All Shortcuts Print a report that lists the shortcuts that are stored in the printer.
Note: Fax Shortcuts appears only when fax is installed.
Fax Shortcuts
Copy Shortcuts
Email Shortcuts
FTP Shortcuts
Network Folder Shortcuts
Fax
Note: This menu appears only if Fax is
configured,
and Enable Job Log is set to On.
Menu item Description
Fax Job Log Print a report about the last 200 completed fax jobs.
Fax Call Log Print a report about the last 100 attempted, received, and blocked calls.
Use printer menus 205
background
Network
Menu item Description
Network Setup Page Print a page that shows the configured network and wireless settings on the
printer.
Note: This menu item appears only in network printers or printers connected
to print servers.
WiFi Direct Connected Clients Print a page that shows the list of devices that are connected to the printer using
WiFi Direct.
Note: This menu item appears only when Enable WiFi Direct is set to On.
Troubleshooting
Menu item Description
Print Quality Test Pages Print sample pages to identify and correct print quality defects.
Cleaning the Scanner Print instructions on how to clean the scanner.
Printing the Menu Settings Page
From the home screen, touch Settings > Reports > Menu Settings Page.
Use printer menus 206
background
Maintain the printer
Checking the status of parts and supplies
1 From the home screen, touch Status/Supplies.
2 Select the parts or supplies that you want to check.
Note: You can also access this setting by touching the top section of the home screen.
Configuring supply notifications
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Device > Notifications.
3 From the Supplies menu, click Custom Supply Notifications.
4 Select a notification for each supply item.
5 Apply the changes.
Setting up email alerts
Configure the printer to send email alerts when supplies are low, when paper must be changed or added, or
when there is a paper jam.
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Device > Notifications > Email Alert Setup, and then configure the settings.
Note: For more information on SMTP settings, contact your email provider.
3 Apply the changes.
4 Click Setup E-mail Lists and Alerts, and then configure the settings.
5 Apply the changes.
Maintain the printer 207
background
Viewing reports
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Reports.
2 Select the report that you want to view.
Ordering parts and supplies
To order supplies in the U.S., contact Lexmark at 1-800-539-6275 for information about Lexmark authorized
supplies dealers in your area. In other countries or regions, go to
www.lexmark.com or contact the place where
you purchased the printer.
Note: All life estimates for printer supplies assume printing on letter or A4size plain paper.
Warning—Potential Damage: Failure to maintain optimum printer performance, or to replace parts and
supplies, may cause damage to your printer.
Using genuine Lexmark parts and supplies
Your Lexmark printer is designed to function best with genuine Lexmark parts and supplies. Use of third-party
supplies or parts may aect the performance, reliability, or life of the printer and its imaging components. It can
also
aect
warranty coverage. Damage caused by the use of third-party parts and supplies is not covered by
the warranty. All life indicators are designed to function with Lexmark parts and supplies, and may deliver
unpredictable results if third-party parts and supplies are used. Imaging component usage beyond the intended
life may damage your Lexmark printer or its associated components.
Warning—Potential Damage: Supplies and parts without Return Program agreement terms may be reset and
remanufactured. However, the manufacturer’s warranty does not cover any damage caused by non-genuine
supplies or parts. Resetting counters on the supply or part without proper remanufacturing can cause
damage to your printer. After resetting the supply or part counter, your printer may display an error indicating
the presence of the reset item.
Ordering a toner cartridge
Notes:
The estimated cartridge yield is based on the ISO/IEC 19798 standard.
Extremely low print coverage for extended periods of time may negatively aect actual yield.
Lexmark CX730 and Lexmark CX735 Return Program cartridges
Item North America Europe Rest of the World
Return Program toner cartridges
Cyan 71C10C0 71C20C0 71C80C0
Magenta 71C10M0 71C20M0 71C80M0
1
Supported only in the Lexmark CX730 printer model.
2
Supported only in the Lexmark CX735 printer model.
For more information on countries in each region, go to
www.lexmark.com/regions.
Maintain the printer 208
background
Item North America Europe Rest of the World
Yellow 71C10Y0 71C20Y0 71C80Y0
Black 71C10K0 71C20K0 71C80K0
High Yield Return Program toner cartridges
1
Cyan 71C1HC0 71C2HC0 71C8HC0
Magenta 71C1HM0 71C2HM0 71C8HM0
Yellow 71C1HY0 71C2HY0 71C8HY0
Black 71C1HK0 71C2HK0 71C8HK0
Extra High Yield Return Program toner cartridges
2
Cyan 81C1XC0 81C2XC0 81C8XC0
Magenta 81C1XM0 81C2XM0 81C8XM0
Yellow 81C1XY0 81C2XY0 81C8XY0
Black 81C1XK0 81C2XK0 81C8XK0
1
Supported only in the Lexmark CX730 printer model.
2
Supported only in the Lexmark CX735 printer model.
For more information on countries in each region, go to
www.lexmark.com/regions.
Lexmark CX730 High yield toner cartridges
Item Worldwide
Cyan 71C0H20
Magenta 71C0H30
Yellow 71C0H40
Black 71C0H10
Lexmark CX735 Extra high yield toner cartridges
Item Worldwide
Cyan 81C0X20
Magenta 81C0X30
Yellow 81C0X40
Black 81C0X10
Lexmark XC4342 and Lexmark XC4352 Toner cartridges
Item Worldwide
Cyan 24B7515
Magenta 24B7516
Yellow 24B7517
Maintain the printer 209
background
Item Worldwide
Black 24B7518
Ordering black imaging unit
Item Part number
Black imaging unit 71C0Z10
Ordering color imaging kit
Item Part number
Color imaging kit 71C0Z50
Ordering a waste toner bottle
Item Part number
Waste toner bottle 71C0W00
Ordering a fuser maintenance kit
Notes:
Using certain types of paper requires more frequent replacement of the maintenance kit.
The separator assembly, fuser, and pick roller assembly are included in the maintenance kit and can be
ordered individually and replaced if necessary.
For more information on replacing the maintenance kit, see the documentation that came with the kit.
Item Part number
Fuser maintenance kit, 110–120 V 41X3882
Fuser maintenance kit, 220–240 V 41X3883
Fuser maintenance kit, 100 V 41X3884
Fuser maintenance kit, 115 V (Narrow media)
*
41X4511
*
Supported only in and required for Lexmark CX737.
Maintain the printer 210
background
Replacing parts and supplies
Replacing a toner cartridge
1 Open door B.
Maintain the printer 211
background
2 Remove the used toner cartridge.
3 Unpack the new toner cartridge.
Maintain the printer 212
background
4 Insert the new toner cartridge.
5 Close door B.
Maintain the printer 213
background
Replacing the black imaging unit
1 Open door B.
Maintain the printer 214
background
2 Remove the waste toner bottle.
Note: To avoid spilling the toner, place the bottle in an upright position.
Maintain the printer 215
background
3 Remove the toner cartridges.
Maintain the printer 216
background
4 Disconnect the imaging kit cable.
Maintain the printer 217
background
5 Remove the imaging kit.
Note: To avoid scratching the imaging kit or damaging the photoconductor drum, place the imaging kit in
an uplifted position.
Maintain the printer 218
background
6 Remove the used black imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the photoconductor unit to direct light for more than 10
minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print quality problems.
Maintain the printer 219
background
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the shiny photoconductor drum under the imaging kit. Doing
so may aect the quality of future print jobs.
7 Unpack the new black imaging unit.
8 Insert the new black imaging unit into the imaging kit.
Maintain the printer 220
background
9 Insert the imaging kit.
Maintain the printer 221
background
10 Connect the imaging kit cable.
11 Insert the waste toner bottle.
12 Insert the toner cartridges.
13 Close door B.
Maintain the printer 222
background
Replacing the color imaging kit
1 Open door B.
Maintain the printer 223
background
2 Remove the waste toner bottle.
Note: To avoid spilling the toner, place the bottle in an upright position.
Maintain the printer 224
background
3 Remove the toner cartridges.
Maintain the printer 225
background
4 Disconnect the imaging kit cable.
Maintain the printer 226
background
5 Remove the used imaging kit.
Maintain the printer 227
background
6 Remove the black imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the photoconductor unit to direct light for more than 10
minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the shiny photoconductor drum under the imaging unit.
Doing so may aect the quality of future print jobs.
7 Unpack the new imaging kit.
Note: The imaging kit includes the imaging kit and the cyan, magenta, and yellow developer units.
Maintain the printer 228
background
8 Insert the black imaging unit into the new imaging kit.
Maintain the printer 229
background
9 Insert the new imaging kit.
Maintain the printer 230
background
10 Connect the imaging kit cable.
11 Insert the waste toner bottle.
12 Insert the toner cartridges.
13 Close door B.
Maintain the printer 231
background
Replacing the waste toner bottle
1 Open door B.
Maintain the printer 232
background
2 Remove the used waste toner bottle.
Note: To avoid spilling the toner, place the bottle in an upright position.
3 Unpack the new waste toner bottle.
4 Insert the new waste toner bottle.
5 Close door B.
6 Dispose the used waste toner bottle properly.
Maintain the printer 233
background
Replacing the fuser
1 Turn
o
the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
2 Open door A, and then open door A1.
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a
hot component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.
Maintain the printer 234
background
3 Remove the used fuser.
4 Unpack the new fuser.
5 Insert the new fuser.
6 Close door A1, and then close door A.
Maintain the printer 235
background
7 Connect the power cord to the electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of
fire
or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
8 Reset the fuser maintenance counter.
For more information, see
“Resetting the maintenance counter” on page 248.
Replacing the pick roller
Replacing the pick roller in the 550sheet tray
1
Turn
o
the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
2 Remove the tray.
Maintain the printer 236
background
3 Remove the used pick roller.
4 Unpack the new pick roller.
Warning—Potential Damage: To avoid damage and poor printer performance, make sure that your hands
are clean when handling the parts.
Maintain the printer 237
background
5 Insert the new pick roller.
6 Insert the tray.
7 Connect the power cord to the electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of
fire
or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
Replacing the pick roller in the multipurpose feeder
1
Turn o the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
2 Open the multipurpose feeder.
Maintain the printer 238
background
3 Remove the used pick roller.
4 Unpack the new pick roller.
Warning—Potential Damage: To avoid damage and poor printer performance, make sure that your hands
are clean when handling the parts.
Maintain the printer 239
background
5 Insert the new pick roller.
6 Close the multipurpose feeder.
7 Connect the power cord to the electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of
fire
or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
Replacing the separator bracket
1 Pull out the tray.
Maintain the printer 240
background
2 Remove the used separator bracket.
3 Unpack the new separator bracket.
Maintain the printer 241
background
4 Insert the new separator bracket.
5 Insert the tray.
Replacing the scanner glass pad
1 Open the scanner cover.
Maintain the printer 242
background
2 Remove the used scanner glass pad.
3 Unpack the new scanner glass pad.
4 Place the white area of the new scanner glass pad facedown on the scanner glass, and then remove the
backing on the tape.
Maintain the printer 243
background
Note: Make sure that the scanner glass pad is aligned correctly on the edges of the scanner glass.
5 Close the scanner cover to stick the new scanner glass pad to the cover.
6 Open the scanner cover to check if the new scanner glass pad is properly attached to the cover.
7 Close the scanner cover.
Replacing the ADF rollers
1 Open door C.
Maintain the printer 244
background
2 Remove the used ADF pick roller.
Maintain the printer 245
background
3 Remove the used ADF separator roller.
4 Unpack the new ADF pick roller and ADF separator roller.
Maintain the printer 246
background
5 Insert the new ADF separator roller until it clicks into place.
Maintain the printer 247
background
6 Insert the new ADF pick roller until it clicks into place.
7 Close door C.
Resetting the maintenance counter
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Maintenance > Configuration Menu > Supply Usage
And Counters.
2 To uc h Reset Maintenance Counter.
Maintain the printer 248
background
Resetting the supply usage counters
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Maintenance >
Configuration
Menu > Supply Usage
And Counters.
2 Select the counter that you want to reset.
Warning—Potential Damage: Supplies and parts without Return Program agreement terms may be reset and
remanufactured. However, the manufacturer’s warranty does not cover any damage caused by non-genuine
supplies or parts. Resetting counters on the supply or part without proper remanufacturing can cause
damage to your printer. After resetting the supply or part counter, your printer may display an error indicating
the presence of the reset item.
Cleaning printer parts
Cleaning the printer
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock when cleaning the exterior of the
printer, unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet and disconnect all cables from the printer before
proceeding.
Notes:
Perform this task after every few months.
Damage to the printer caused by improper handling is not covered by the printer warranty.
1 Turn o the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
2 Remove paper from the standard bin and multipurpose feeder.
3 Remove any dust, lint, and pieces of paper around the printer using a soft brush or vacuum.
4 Wipe the outside of the printer with a damp, soft, lintfree cloth.
Notes:
Do not use household cleaners or detergents, as they may damage the finish of the printer.
Make sure that all areas of the printer are dry after cleaning.
5 Connect the power cord to the electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of
fire
or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
Cleaning the touch screen
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electric shock when cleaning the exterior of the
printer, unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet and disconnect all cables from the printer before
proceeding.
1 Turn o the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
2 Using a damp, soft, lintfree cloth, wipe the touch screen.
Maintain the printer 249
background
Notes:
Do not use household cleaners or detergents, as they may damage the touch screen.
Make sure that the touch screen is dry after cleaning.
3 Connect the power cord to the electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
Cleaning the scanner
1 Open the scanner cover.
2 Using a damp, soft, lint-free cloth, wipe the following areas:
ADF glass pad
Scanner glass pad
Maintain the printer 250
background
ADF glass
Scanner glass
3 Close the scanner cover.
4 Open door C.
5 Using a damp, soft, lint-free cloth, wipe the following areas:
ADF glass pad in door C
Maintain the printer 251
background
ADF glass in door C
6 Close door C.
Cleaning the pick tires
1 Turn
o
the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
2 Remove the tray.
Maintain the printer 252
background
3 Remove the pick roller.
4 Apply isopropyl alcohol to a soft, lint-free cloth, and then wipe the pick tires.
Maintain the printer 253
background
5 Insert the pick roller.
6 Insert the tray.
7 Connect the power cord to the electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of
fire
or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
Cleaning the pick roller in the multipurpose feeder
1 Turn
o
the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
2 Open the multipurpose feeder.
Maintain the printer 254
background
3 Remove the pick roller.
4 Apply isopropyl alcohol to a soft, lint-free cloth, and then wipe the pick roller.
Maintain the printer 255
background
5 Insert the pick roller.
6 Close the multipurpose feeder.
7 Connect the power cord to the electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of
fire
or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
Cleaning the ADF rollers
1 Open door C.
Maintain the printer 256
background
2 Remove the ADF pick roller.
Maintain the printer 257
background
3 Remove the ADF separator roller.
4 Apply isopropyl alcohol to a soft, lint-free cloth, and then wipe the ADF pick roller and ADF separator roller.
Maintain the printer 258
background
5 Insert the ADF separator roller until it clicks into place.
Maintain the printer 259
background
6 Insert the ADF pick roller until it clicks into place.
7 Close door C.
Maintain the printer 260
background
Saving energy and paper
Configuring the power save mode settings
Sleep mode
1
From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Power Management > Timeouts > Sleep Mode.
2 Specify the amount of time that the printer stays idle before it enters Sleep Mode.
Hibernate mode
1
From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Power Management > Timeouts > Hibernate Timeout.
2 Select the amount of time that the printer stays idle before it enters Hibernate mode.
Notes:
For Hibernate Timeout to work, set Hibernate Timeout on Connection to Hibernate.
The Embedded Web Server is disabled when the printer is in Hibernate mode.
Adjusting the brightness of the display
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Preferences.
2 In the Screen Brightness menu, adjust the setting.
Conserving supplies
Print on both sides of the paper.
Note: Two-sided printing is the default setting in the print driver.
Print multiple pages on a single sheet of paper.
Use the preview feature to see how the document looks like before printing it.
Print one copy of the document to check its content and format for accuracy.
Moving the printer to another location
Moving the printer to another location
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: If the printer weight is greater than 20 kg (44 lb), then it may require
two or more people to lift it safely.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, use only the power cord
provided with this product or the manufacturer's authorized replacement.
Maintain the printer 261
background
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: When moving the printer, follow these guidelines to avoid personal
injury or printer damage:
Make sure that all doors and trays are closed.
Turn o the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
Disconnect all cords and cables from the printer.
If the printer has separate floor-standing optional trays or output options attached to it, then disconnect
them before moving the printer.
If the printer has a caster base, then carefully roll it to the new location. Use caution when passing over
thresholds and breaks in
flooring.
If the printer does not have a caster base but is configured with optional trays or output options, then remove
the output options and lift the printer
o
the trays. Do not try to lift the printer and any options at the same
time.
Always use the handholds on the printer to lift it.
Any cart used to move the printer must have a surface able to support the full footprint of the printer.
Any cart used to move the hardware options must have a surface able to support the dimensions of the
options.
Keep the printer in an upright position.
Avoid severe jarring movements.
Make sure that your fingers are not under the printer when you set it down.
Make sure that there is adequate clearance around the printer.
Note: Damage to the printer caused by improper moving is not covered by the printer warranty.
Shipping the printer
For shipping instructions, go to http://support.lexmark.com or contact customer support.
Maintain the printer 262
background
Troubleshoot a problem
Print quality problems
Find the image that resembles the print quality problem you are having, and then click the link below it to read
problem-solving steps.
“Blank or white pages” on
page 273
“Dark print” on page 275 “Ghost images” on page 277 “Gray or colored background”
on page 278
“Incorrect margins” on
page 279
“Light print” on page 279
“Missing colors” on page
282
“Mottled print and dots” on
page 284
“Paper curl” on page
285
“Print crooked or skewed”
on page 286
“Solid color or black images”
on page 287
“Text or images cut
o”
on
page 288
Troubleshoot a problem 263
background
“Toner easily rubs o” on
page 290
“Uneven print density” on
page 291
“Horizontal dark lines” on
page 292
“Vertical dark lines” on
page 293
“Horizontal white lines
on page 294
“Vertical white lines” on
page 295
“Repeating defects” on
page 297
Printer error codes
Error codes Error message Solution
8.01 Close all doors. Close all doors, and then insert the
waste toner bottle.
8.03 Close door C. Keep all doors closed unless
performing maintenance.
9.00 Printer had to restart.
Last job may be incomplete.
Tou ch Continue to clear the message
and continue printing.
11.11, 11.21, 11.31, 11.41, 11.51 Load <source/> with <type/>
<size/>.
Open the indicated tray, and then
load paper. For more information, see
“Loading trays” on page 49.
11.12, 11.22, 11.32, 11.42, 11.52 Load <source/> with <type/>
<size/> <orientation/>.
Open the indicated tray, and then
load paper. For more information, see
“Loading trays” on page 49.
11.91 Load multipurpose feeder
with <type/> <size/>.
Open the multipurpose feeder, and
then load paper. For more
information, see
“Loading the
multipurpose feeder” on page 52.
Troubleshoot a problem 264
background
Error codes Error message Solution
11.92 Load multipurpose feeder
with <type/> <size/>
<orientation/>.
Open the multipurpose feeder, and
then load paper. For more
information, see
“Loading the
multipurpose feeder” on page 52.
12.11, 12.21, 12.31, 12.41, 12.51 Change <source/> to <type/>
<size/>.
Open the indicated tray, remove
paper, and then load the correct
paper type and size. For more
information, see
“Loading trays” on
page 49.
12.12, 12.22, 12.32, 12.42, 12.52 Change <source/> to <type/>
<size/> <orientation/>.
Open the indicated tray, remove
paper, and then load the correct
paper type and size. For more
information, see
“Loading trays” on
page 49.
12.91 Change multipurpose feeder
to <type/> <size/>.
Remove paper, and then load the
correct paper type and size. For more
information, see
“Loading the
multipurpose feeder” on page 52.
12.92 Change multipurpose feeder
to <type/> <size/>
<orientation/>.
Remove paper, and then load the
correct paper type and size. For more
information, see
“Loading the
multipurpose feeder” on page 52.
29.08 Reminder: Remove packaging.
1 Open door A, and then remove
the packing material inside the
printer.
2 Pull out each of the three red
clips starting with the upper left,
lower left, and ending on the right
side.
3 Close door A.
4 Open door B.
5 Pull the red loop on the right side
straight out.
6 Close door B.
31.30 Transfer module problem.
Restart printer.
1 Turn
o
the printer, and then
unplug the power cord from the
electrical outlet.
2 Connect the power cord to the
electrical outlet, and then turn on
the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL
INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire
or electrical shock, connect the
power cord to an appropriately
rated and properly grounded
electrical outlet that is near the
product and easily accessible.
Troubleshoot a problem 265
background
Error codes Error message Solution
31.35 Reinstall missing or
unresponsive waste toner
bottle.
1 Open door B.
2 Remove the waste toner bottle.
Note: To avoid spilling the toner,
place the bottle in an upright
position.
3 Insert the waste toner bottle.
4 Close door B.
31.40, 31.41, 31.42, 31.43 Reinstall missing or
unresponsive [color]
cartridge.
1 Open door B.
2 Remove the cartridge.
3 Insert the cartridge.
4 Close door B.
31.60 Reinstall missing or
unresponsive black imaging
unit.
1 Open door B.
2 Remove the waste toner bottle.
Note: To avoid spilling the toner,
place the bottle in an upright
position.
3 Remove the toner cartridges.
4 Disconnect the imaging kit cable.
5 Remove the imaging kit.
Note: To avoid scratching the
imaging kit or damaging the
photoconductor drum, place the
imaging kit in an uplifted
position.
6 Remove the black imaging unit.
Warning—Potential
Damage: Do not expose the
photoconductor unit to direct
light for more than 10 minutes.
Extended exposure to light may
cause print quality problems.
Warning—Potential
Damage: Do not touch the shiny
photoconductor drum under the
imaging unit. Doing so may
aect
the quality of future print
jobs.
7 Insert the black imaging unit.
8 Insert the imaging kit.
9 Connect the imaging kit cable.
10 Insert the toner cartridges.
11 Insert the waste toner bottle.
12 Close door B.
Troubleshoot a problem 266
background
Error codes Error message Solution
31.64 Reinstall missing,
unplugged, or unresponsive
color imaging kit.
1 Open door B.
2 Remove the waste toner bottle.
Note: To avoid spilling the toner,
place the bottle in an upright
position.
3 Remove the cartridges.
4 Disconnect the imaging kit cable.
5 Remove the imaging kit.
6 Insert the imaging kit.
7 Connect the imaging kit cable.
8 Insert the cartridges.
9 Insert the waste toner bottle.
10 Close door B.
31.80 Reinstall missing or
unresponsive fuser.
1 Open door A, and then open
door A1.
CAUTION—HOT
SURFACE: The inside of the
printer might be hot. To reduce
the risk of injury from a hot
component, allow the surface to
cool before touching it.
2 Remove the fuser.
3 Insert the fuser.
4 Close door A1, and then close
door A.
32.40, 32.41, 32.42, 32.43 Replace unsupported [color]
cartridge.
For more information, see
“Replacing
a toner cartridge” on page 211.
32.60 Replace unsupported black
imaging unit.
For more information, see
“Replacing
the black imaging unit” on page 214.
32.64 Replace unsupported color
imaging kit.
For more information, see
“Replacing
the color imaging kit” on page 223.
Troubleshoot a problem 267
background
Error codes Error message Solution
32.xy Replace unsupported fuser.
1 Open door A, and then open
door A1.
CAUTION—HOT
SURFACE: The inside of the
printer might be hot. To reduce
the risk of injury from a hot
component, allow the surface to
cool before touching it.
2 Locate the fuser type at the
bottom of the fuser.
Notes:
All printer models except
Lexmark CX737 support the
fuser types 00, 01, and 02.
Lexmark CX737 only
supports fuser type 05.
3 If the fuser is not supported,
remove the fuser, and then install
a supported one. For more
information, see
“Replacing the
fuser” on page 234.
33.40, 33.41, 33.42, 33.43 Non-Lexmark [color]
cartridge, seeUser's Guide.
For more information, see
“NonLexmark supply” on page 322.
33.60 Non-Lexmark black imaging
unit, seeUser's Guide.
For more information, see
“NonLexmark supply” on page 322.
33.64 Non-Lexmark color imaging
kit, seeUser's Guide.
For more information, see
“NonLexmark supply” on page 322.
37.1 Insufficient memory to
collate job.
Try one or more of the following:
To uc h Continue to print the part
of the job that is stored and to
begin collating the rest of the print
job.
Cancel the current print job.
Troubleshoot a problem 268
background
Error codes Error message Solution
37.3 Insufficient memory, some
held jobs were deleted.
Tou ch Continue to clear the message
and continue printing.
39.1 Complex page, some data may
not have printed.
Try one or more of the following:
To uc h Continue to clear the
message and continue printing.
Cancel the current print job.
Install more printer memory.
Reduce the complexity and size of
the print job before sending it to
print again.
Reduce the number of pages
in the print job.
Reduce the number and size
of any downloaded fonts.
Delete any unnecessary fonts
or macros from the print job.
Reduce the number of
graphics in the print job.
42.xy Replace [color] cartridge,
printer region mismatch.
For more information, see
“Replace
cartridge, printer region mismatch”
on page 321.
43.40, 43.41, 43.42, 43.43 Replace defective [color]
cartridge.
For more information, see
“Replacing
a toner cartridge” on page 211.
43.40, 43.41, 43.42, 43.43 [Color] cartridge problem.
1 Open door B.
2 Remove the cartridge.
3 Insert the cartridge.
4 Close door B.
If the problem persists, then replace
the cartridge.
55.1 Error reading USB drive.
Remove USB.
Remove the flash drive to continue.
55.2 Error reading USB hub.
Remove hub.
Remove the USB hub to continue.
Troubleshoot a problem 269
background
Error codes Error message Solution
58 Too many trays attached.
1 Turn o the printer, and then
unplug the power cord from the
electrical outlet.
2 Remove one or more trays.
3 Connect the power cord to the
electrical outlet, and then turn on
the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL
INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or
electrical shock, connect the power
cord to an appropriately rated and
properly grounded electrical outlet
that is near the product and easily
accessible.
59 Incompatible tray [x].
1 Turn o the printer, and then
unplug the power cord from the
electrical outlet.
2 Remove the indicated tray.
3 Connect the power cord to the
electrical outlet, and then turn on
the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL
INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or
electrical shock, connect the power
cord to an appropriately rated and
properly grounded electrical outlet
that is near the product and easily
accessible.
61 Defective disk. Replace the defective storage drive.
62 Disk full. Try one or more of the following:
To uc h Continue to clear the
message.
Delete fonts, macros, and other
data stored in the printer hard
disk.
Install a printer hard disk.
63 Format the disk. Formatting now wipes all information
from the storage drive.
To format the disk, do the following:
1 From the home screen, touch
Settings > Device >
Maintenance > Out of Service
Erase.
2 Tou ch Sanitize all information
on hard disk, and then touch
ERASE.
Troubleshoot a problem 270
background
Error codes Error message Solution
71.01 Fax Station Name not set
up. Contact system
administrator.
For more information, see
“Setting up
the fax function using analog fax” on
page 34.
71.02 Fax Station Number not set
up. Contact system
administrator.
71.03 No analog phone line
connected to modem, fax is
disabled.
Check the connection and the line for
a signal. For more information, see
“Setting up fax using a standard
telephone line” on page 36.
71.06 Unable to connect to HTTPS
Fax Server.
Connection to HTTPS Fax Server is
disconnected. Check the Internet
connection of the printer.
71.12 Memory full, cannot print
faxes.
Tou ch Print All to print as many of the
faxes as have been saved.
71.13 Memory full. Cannot send
faxes.
Try one or more of the following:
Continue and try sending the fax
again.
Scan the original document one
page at a time, dial the fax
number, and then scan the
document.
72.01 E-mail SMTP server not set
up. Contact system
administrator.
Try either of the following:
Set up your email function. For
more information, see
“Configuring the email SMTP
settings” on page 40.
Disable the error message. For
more information, see
“Disabling
the 'SMTP server not set up' error
message” on page 325.
80.01, 80.09 Maintenance kit nearly low. Tou ch Continue to clear the
message.
80.11, 80.19 Maintenance kit low. Tou ch Continue to clear the
message.
80.21, 80.29 Maintenance kit very low. Tou ch Continue to clear the
message.
80.31 Replace maintenance kit,
recommended life exceeded.
For more information, see
“Ordering
a fuser maintenance kit” on page
210.
82.00, 82.02, 82.09 Waste toner bottle nearly
full.
Tou ch Continue to clear the
message.
82.12, 82.13, 82.19, 82.20, 82.22,
82.23, 82.29
Waste toner bottle almost
full.
Tou ch Continue to clear the
message.
Troubleshoot a problem 271
background
Error codes Error message Solution
82.30, 82.30, 82.33, 82.39, 82.40,
82.42, 82.49
Replace waste toner bottle. For more information, see
“Replacing
the waste toner bottle” on page 232.
84.01, 84.09 Black imaging unit or color
imaging kit nearly low.
Tou ch Continue to clear the
message.
84.11, 84.13, 84.19 Black imaging unit or color
imaging kit low.
Tou ch Continue to clear the
message.
84.21, 84.23, 84.29 Black imaging unit or color
imaging kit very low.
Tou ch Continue to clear the
message.
84.31, 84.33, 84.41, 84.43, 84.48 Replace black imaging unit
or color imaging kit.
For more information, see
“Replacing the black imaging
unit” on page 214.
For more information, see
“Replacing the color imaging kit”
on page 223.
88.00, 88.08, 88.09 [Color] cartridge nearly
low.
Tou ch Continue to clear the
message.
88.10, 88.18, 88.19 [Color] cartridge low.
88.20, 88.28, 88.29 [Color] cartridge very low.
88.30, 88.37, 88.38, 88.40, 88.47,
88.48
Replace the [color]
cartridge.
For more information, see
“Replacing
a toner cartridge” on page 211.
200.23, 200.33, 200.43, 200.53,
232.23, 232.33, 232.43, 232.53,
240.23, 240.33, 240.43, 240.53,
242.33, 242.35, 242.43, 242.45,
242.53, 242.55, 243.43, 243.45,
243.53, 243.55, 244.53, 244.54,
244.55, 245.56, 662.23, 663.33,
664.43, 665.53
Paper jam, [jam header].
[xxx.yy]
For more information, see
“Paper jam
in trays” on page 309.
200.03, 240.05, 240.06, 240.82,
240.83, 240.84, 647.82, 647.83,
647.84, 647.85, 648.82, 648.83,
648.84, 648.85, 649.82, 649.83,
649.84, 649.85, 650.82, 650.83,
650.84, 650.85, 660.81, 660.82,
660.83, 660.84, 660.85, 660.86
Paper jam, [jam header].
[xxx.yy]
For more information, see
“Paper jam
in the multipurpose feeder” on
page 310.
230.03, 230.13, 230.23, 230.33,
230.43, 230.53
Paper jam, [jam header].
[xxx.yy]
For more information, see
“Paper jam
in the standard bin” on page 311.
280.11, 280.13, 280.15, 280.91, 280.93,
280.95, 281.11, 281.15, 281.16, 281.91,
281.95, 281.96, 284.11, 284.13, 284.15,
284.91, 284.93, 284.95, 288.10,
288.90, 295.01, 680.10, 680.20,
680.40
Scanner jam. [xxx.yy] For more information, see
“Paper jam
in the automatic document feeder”
on page 310.
Troubleshoot a problem 272
background
Printing problems
Print quality is poor
Blank or white pages
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Troubleshoot a problem 273
background
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Make sure to remove all the packing material in the following
areas:
Inside the printer
Toner cartridges and imaging unit
b Print the document.
Is the printer printing blank or white pages?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 274
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a Check if the printer is using a genuine and supported Lexmark
toner cartridge.
Note: If the cartridge is not supported, then install a
supported one.
b Print the document.
Is the printer printing blank or white pages?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may
aect
the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Is the printer printing blank or white pages?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Dark print
Note: Before solving the problem, print the quality sample pages to determine the missing color. From the
home screen, touch Settings > Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Perform Color Adjust.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality >
Advanced Imaging > Color Adjust.
b Print the document.
Is the print too dark?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 275
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a Depending on your operating system, reduce the toner
darkness from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Note: You can also change the settings on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Print >
Quality > Toner Dar kness.
b Print the document.
Is the print too dark?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the settings match the paper loaded in
the tray.
You can also change the settings on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray Conguration > Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Is the print too dark?
Go to step 4. Go to step 6.
Step 4
Make sure that the paper has no texture or rough finishes.
Are you printing on textured or rough paper?
Go to step 5. Go to step 6.
Step 5
a Replace textured or rough paper with plain paper.
b Print the document.
Is the print too dark?
Go to step 6. The problem is
solved.
Step 6
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you are ready to use it.
b Print the document.
Is the print too dark?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 276
background
Ghost images
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Load the tray with the correct paper type and weight.
b Print the document.
Do ghost images appear on prints?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded in
the tray.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray
Configuration
> Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Do ghost images appear on prints?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
a Perform Color Adjust.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality >
Advanced Imaging > Color Adjust.
b Print the document.
Do ghost images appear on prints?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 277
background
Gray or colored background
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Depending on your operating system, increase toner darkness
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Note: You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Print >
Quality > Toner Dar kness.
b Print the document.
Does gray or colored background appear on prints?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Perform Color Adjust.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality >
Advanced Imaging > Color Adjust.
b Print the document.
Does gray or colored background appear on prints?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may aect the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Does gray or colored background appear on prints?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 278
background
Incorrect margins
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Adjust the paper guides in the tray to the correct position for
the paper loaded.
b Print the document.
Are the margins correct?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper size
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray Conguration > Paper Size/Type.
Note:
b Print the document.
Are the margins correct?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Light print
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Troubleshoot a problem 279
background
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Make sure to remove all the packing material in the following
areas:
Inside the printer
Toner cartridges and imaging unit
b Print the document.
Is the print light?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 280
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a Perform Color Adjust.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality >
Advanced Imaging > Color Adjust.
b Print the document.
Is the print light?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
a Depending on your operating system, increase toner darkness
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Note: You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Print >
Quality > Toner Dar kness.
b Print the document.
Is the print light?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Step 4
a Turn o Color Saver.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality > Color
Saver.
b Print the document.
Is the print light?
Go to step 5. The problem is
solved.
Step 5
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray
Configuration
> Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Is the print light?
Go to step 6. The problem is
solved.
Step 6
Check if paper has texture or rough finishes.
Are you printing on textured or rough paper?
Go to step 7. Go to step 7.
Step 7
a Replace textured or rough paper with plain paper.
b Print the document.
Is the print light?
Go to step 8. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 281
background
Action Yes No
Step 8
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you are ready to use it.
b Print the document.
Is the print light?
Go to step 9. The problem is
solved.
Step 9
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may aect the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Is the print too light?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Missing colors
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Troubleshoot a problem 282
background
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Make sure to remove all the packing material in the following
areas:
Inside the printer
Toner cartridges and imaging unit
b Print the document.
Are some colors missing on print?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 283
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a Remove the color imaging kit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit to direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended
exposure to light may cause print quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit. Doing so
may aect the quality of future print jobs.
b Remove the toner cartridge of the missing color.
c Remove, and then insert the developer unit of the missing color.
d Insert the toner cartridge of the missing color.
e Insert the color imaging kit.
f Print the document.
Are some colors missing on print?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Mottled print and dots
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
Step 1
Check the printer for leaked toner contamination.
Is the printer free of leaked toner?
Go to step 2. Contact
customer
support.
Step 2
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper > Tray
Configuration > Paper Size/Type.
b Check if the paper size and paper type settings match the
paper loaded.
Note: Make sure that the paper does not have texture or
rough finishes.
Do the settings match?
Go to step 4. Go to step 3.
Troubleshoot a problem 284
background
Action Yes No
Step 3
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper size
and paper type from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the settings match the paper loaded in
the tray.
You can also change the settings on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray Conguration > Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Is the print mottled?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Step 4
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you are ready to use it.
b Print the document.
Is the print mottled?
Go to step 5. The problem is
solved.
Step 5
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may
aect
the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Is the print mottled?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Paper curl
Troubleshoot a problem 285
background
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Adjust the guides in the tray to the correct position for the paper
loaded.
b Print the document.
Is the paper curled?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray Conguration > Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Is the paper curled?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
Print on the other side of the paper.
a Remove paper, flip it over, and then reload paper.
b Print the document.
Is the paper curled?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Step 4
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you are ready to use it.
b Print the document.
Is the paper curled?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Print crooked or skewed
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Troubleshoot a problem 286
background
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Pull out the tray.
b Remove the paper, and then load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you are ready to use it.
c Adjust the paper guides in the tray to the correct position for
the paper loaded.
d Insert the tray.
e Print the document.
Is the print crooked or skewed?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Make sure that you are printing on a supported paper.
b Print the document.
Is the print crooked or skewed?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Solid color or black images
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Troubleshoot a problem 287
background
Action Yes No
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may aect the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Is the printer printing solid color or black images?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Text or images cut o
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Troubleshoot a problem 288
background
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Make sure to remove all the packing material in the following
areas:
Inside the printer
Toner cartridges and imaging unit
b Print the document.
Is the text or image clipped?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 289
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a Adjust the paper guides in the tray to the correct position for
the paper loaded.
b Print the document.
Is the text or image clipped?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper size
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded in
the tray.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray
Configuration
> Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Is the text or image clipped?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Step 4
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may aect the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Is the text or image clipped?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Toner easily rubs o
Troubleshoot a problem 290
background
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
1 Depending on your operating system, specify the
paper type from the Printing Preferences or Print
dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper
loaded.
You can also change the setting on the printer
control panel. From the home screen, touch
Settings > Paper > Tray Conguration > Paper
Size/Type.
2 Print the document.
Does the toner rub o?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is solved.
Uneven print density
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may aect the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Is the print density uneven?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 291
background
Horizontal dark lines
Notes:
Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
If horizontal dark lines keep appearing on the prints, then see the “Repeating defects” topic.
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray
Configuration
> Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Do horizontal dark lines appear on prints?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you use it.
b Print the document.
Do horizontal dark lines appear on prints?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 292
background
Action Yes No
Step 3
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may aect the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Do horizontal dark lines appear on prints?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Vertical dark lines
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded in
the tray.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray
Configuration
> Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Do vertical dark lines appear on prints?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 293
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you use it.
b Print the document.
Do vertical dark lines appear on prints?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may aect the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Do vertical dark lines appear on prints?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Horizontal white lines
Notes:
Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
If horizontal white lines keep appearing on the prints, then see the “Repeating defects” topic.
Troubleshoot a problem 294
background
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded in
the tray.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray Conguration > Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Do horizontal white lines appear on prints?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Load the specified paper source with the recommended paper
type.
b Print the document.
Do horizontal white lines appear on prints?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may
aect
the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Do horizontal white lines appear on prints?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Vertical white lines
Troubleshoot a problem 295
background
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded in
the tray.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray
Configuration
> Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Do vertical white lines appear on prints?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
Check if you are using the recommended paper type.
a Load the specified paper source with the recommended paper
type.
b Print the document.
Do vertical white lines appear on prints?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may aect the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Do vertical white lines appear on prints?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 296
background
Repeating defects
Note: Before solving the problem, print the quality sample pages to determine the cause of the repeating
defects. From the home screen, touch Settings > Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Troubleshoot a problem 297
background
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Make sure to remove all the packing material in the following
areas:
Inside the printer
Toner cartridges and imaging unit
b Print the document.
Do the defects still appear?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 298
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
Determine how many colors have defects.
Is only one color aected?
Go to step 3. Go to step 3.
Step 3
a Using the Maintenance Defect Ruler, measure the distance
between the repeating defects on the aected color page.
b Replace the supply item that matches the measurement on the
aected color page.
Color imaging kit or black imaging unit
94.5 mm (3.72 in.)
29.9 mm (1.18 in.)
23.2 mm (0.91 in.)
Developer unit
43.6 mm (1.72 in.)
45.0 mm (1.77 in.)
c Print the Print Quality Test Pages.
Do the defects still appear?
Take note of the
distance, and then
contact
customer
support or your
service
representative.
The problem is
solved.
Step 4
a Using the Maintenance Defect Ruler, measure the distance
between the repeating defects on the aected color page.
b Replace the supply item that matches the measurement on the
aected color page.
Transfer module
37.7 mm (1.48 in.)
78.5 mm (3.09 in.)
54.6 mm (2.15 in.)
Fuser
95 mm (3.74 in.)
110 mm (4.33 in.)
c Print the Print Quality Test Pages.
Do the defects still appear?
Take note of the
distance, and then
contact
customer
support or your
service
representative.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 299
background
Print jobs do not print
Action Yes No
Step 1
a From the document you are trying to print, open the Print
dialog, and then check if you have selected the correct printer.
b Print the document.
Is the document printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
a Check if the printer is on.
b Resolve any error messages that appear on the display.
c Print the document.
Is the document printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
a Check if the ports are working and if the cables are securely
connected to the computer and the printer.
For more information, see the setup documentation that came
with the printer.
b Print the document.
Is the document printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 4.
Step 4
a Turn o the printer, wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn on
the printer.
b Print the document.
Is the document printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 5.
Step 5
a Remove, and then reinstall the print driver.
b Print the document.
Is the document printed?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshoot a problem 300
background
Confidential and other held documents do not print
Action Yes No
Step 1
a From the control panel, check if the documents appear in the
Held Jobs list.
Note: If the documents are not listed, then print the
documents using the Print and Hold options.
b Print the documents.
Are the documents printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
The print job may contain a formatting error or invalid data.
Delete the print job, and then send it again.
For PDF files, generate a new file, and then print the
documents.
Are the documents printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
If you are printing from the Internet, then the printer may be reading
the multiple job titles as duplicates.
For Windows users
a Open the Printing Preferences dialog.
b From the Print and Hold tab, click Use Print and Hold, and then
click Keep duplicate documents.
c Enter a PIN, and then save the changes.
d Send the print job.
For Macintosh users
a Save and name each job dierently.
b Send the job individually.
Are the documents printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 4.
Step 4
a Delete some held jobs to free up printer memory.
b Print the documents.
Are the documents printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 5.
Step 5
a Add printer memory.
b Print the documents.
Are the documents printed?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshoot a problem 301
background
Job prints from the wrong tray or on the wrong paper
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Check if you are printing on the correct paper.
b Print the document.
Is the document printed on the correct paper?
Go to step 2. Load the correct
paper size and paper
type.
Step 2
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper size
and paper type from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Note: You can also change the settings on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper > Tray
Configuration > Paper Size/Type.
b Make sure that the settings match the paper loaded.
c Print the document.
Is the document printed on the correct paper?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
a Check if the trays are linked.
For more information, see
“Linking trays” on page 54.
b Print the document.
Is the document printed from the correct tray?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Slow printing
Action Yes No
Step 1
Make sure that the printer cable is securely connected to the
printer and to the computer, print server, option, or other network
device.
Is the printer printing slow?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Make sure that the printer is not in Quiet Mode.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Maintenance
> Configuration Menu > Device Operations > Quiet Mode.
b Print the document.
Is the printer printing slow?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 302
background
Action Yes No
Step 3
a Depending on your operating system, specify the print
resolution from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
b Set the resolution to 4800 CQ.
c Print the document.
Is the printer printing slow?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Step 4
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality > Print
Resolution.
b Set the resolution to 4800 CQ.
c Print the document.
Is the printer printing slow?
Go to step 5. The problem is
solved.
Step 5
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray Conguration > Paper Size/Type.
Heavier paper prints more slowly.
Paper narrower than letter, A4, and legal may print more
slowly.
b Print the document.
Is the printer printing slow?
Go to step 6. The problem is
solved.
Step 6
a Make sure that the printer settings for texture and weight match
the paper being loaded.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper > Media
Configuration
> Media Types.
Note: Rough paper texture and heavy paper weight may print
more slowly.
b Print the document.
Is the printer printing slow?
Go to step 7. The problem is
solved.
Step 7
Remove held jobs.
Is the printer printing slow?
Go to step 8. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 303
background
Action Yes No
Step 8
a Make sure that the printer is not overheating.
Notes:
Allow the printer to cool down after a long print job.
Observe the recommended ambient temperature for the
printer. For more information, see
“Selecting a location
for the printer” on page 20.
b Print the document.
Is the printer printing slow?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
The printer is not responding
Action Yes No
Step 1
Check if the power cord is connected to the electrical outlet.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or
electrical shock, connect the power cord to an appropriately
rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the
product and easily accessible.
Is the printer responding?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Check if the electrical outlet is turned o by a switch or breaker.
Is the electrical outlet turned o by a switch or breaker?
Turn on the switch or
reset the breaker.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Check if the printer is on.
Is the printer on?
Go to step 4. Turn on the printer.
Step 4
Check if the printer is in Sleep or Hibernate mode.
Is the printer in Sleep or Hibernate mode?
Press the power
button to wake the
printer.
Go to step 5.
Step 5
Check if the cables connecting the printer and the computer are
inserted to the correct ports.
Are the cables inserted to the correct ports?
Go to step 6. Insert the cables to
the correct ports.
Troubleshoot a problem 304
background
Action Yes No
Step 6
Turn o the printer, install the hardware options, and then turn on
the printer.
For more information, see the documentation that came with the
option.
Is the printer responding?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 7.
Step 7
Install the correct print driver.
Is the printer responding?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 8.
Step 8
Turn o the printer, wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn on the
printer.
Is the printer responding?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Unable to read flash drive
Action Yes No
Step 1
Check if the printer is not busy processing another print, copy,
scan, or fax job.
Is the printer ready?
Go to step 3. Go to step 2.
Step 2
Wait for the printer to
finish
processing the other job.
Remove, and then insert the flash drive.
Does the printer recognize the flash drive?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Check if the flash drive is inserted into the front USB port.
Note: The flash drive does not work when it is inserted into the
rear USB port.
Is the
flash
drive inserted into the correct port?
Go to step 5. Go to step 4.
Step 4
Insert the flash drive into the correct port.
Does the printer recognize the flash drive?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 5.
Troubleshoot a problem 305
background
Action Yes No
Step 5
Check if the flash drive is supported. For more information, see
“Supported flash drives and file types” on page 106.
Is the flash drive supported?
Go to step 7. Go to step 6.
Step 6
Insert a supported flash drive.
Does the printer recognize the flash drive?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 7.
Step 7
Remove, and then insert the flash drive.
Does the printer recognize the flash drive?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Enabling the USB port
From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > USB > Enable USB Port.
Clearing jams
Avoiding jams
Load paper properly
Make sure that the paper lies flat in the tray.
Correct loading of paper Incorrect loading of paper
Do not load or remove a tray while the printer is printing.
Do not load too much paper. Make sure that the stack height is below the maximum paper fill indicator.
Troubleshoot a problem 306
background
Do not slide paper into the tray. Load paper as shown in the illustration.
Make sure that the paper guides are positioned correctly and are not pressing tightly against the paper or
envelopes.
Push the tray firmly into the printer after loading paper.
Use recommended paper
Use only recommended paper or specialty media.
Do not load paper that is wrinkled, creased, damp, bent, or curled.
Flex, fan, and align the paper edges before loading.
Do not use paper that has been cut or trimmed by hand.
Do not mix paper sizes, weights, or types in the same tray.
Make sure that the paper size and type are set correctly on the computer or printer control panel.
Store paper according to manufacturer recommendations.
Identifying jam locations
Notes:
When Jam Assist is set to On, the printer flushes blank pages or pages with partial prints after a jammed
page has been cleared. Check your printed output for blank pages.
When Jam Recovery is set to On or Auto, the printer reprints jammed pages.
Troubleshoot a problem 307
background
Jam locations
1 ADF
2 Standard bin
3 Door A
4 Multipurpose feeder
5 Trays
Troubleshoot a problem 308
background
Paper jam in trays
1 Remove the tray.
Warning—Potential Damage: A sensor inside the optional tray is easily damaged by static electricity.
Touch a metal surface before removing the jammed paper in the tray.
2 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
3 Insert the tray.
Troubleshoot a problem 309
background
Paper jam in the automatic document feeder
1 Remove all original documents from the ADF tray.
2 Open door C.
3 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
4 Close door C.
Paper jam in the multipurpose feeder
1 Remove paper from the multipurpose feeder.
2 Pull out the tray.
3 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
Troubleshoot a problem 310
background
4 Insert the tray.
Paper jam in the standard bin
Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
Paper jam in door A
Paper jam in the fuser area
1
Open door A.
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a
hot component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.
Troubleshoot a problem 311
background
2 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
3 Open door A1.
Troubleshoot a problem 312
background
4 Open the fuser access door.
5 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
6 Close and latch the fuser access door.
7 Close door A1, and then close door A.
Paper jam behind door A
1
Open door A.
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a
hot component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.
Troubleshoot a problem 313
background
2 Open the isolation unit door.
3 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
Troubleshoot a problem 314
background
4 Close and latch the isolation unit door.
5 Close door A.
Paper jam in the duplex area
1
Open door A.
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a
hot component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.
2 Open the duplex cover.
3 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
Troubleshoot a problem 315
background
4 Close the duplex cover, and then close door A.
Network connection problems
Cannot open Embedded Web Server
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Check if the printer is on.
b Access the printer Embedded Web Server (EWS).
Can you open the EWS?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
a Make sure that the printer IP address is correct.
Notes:
View the IP address on the home screen.
An IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated
by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
b Access the EWS.
Can you open the EWS?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
a Make sure that you installed a supported browser:
Internet Explorer version 11 or later
Microsoft Edge
Safari version 6 or later
Google Chrome
TM
version 32 or later
Mozilla Firefox version 24 or later
b Access the EWS.
Can you open the EWS?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 4.
Troubleshoot a problem 316
background
Action Yes No
Step 4
a Check if the network connection is working.
Note: If the connection is not working, then contact your
administrator.
b Access the EWS.
Can you open the EWS?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 5.
Step 5
a Make sure that the cable connections to the printer and print
server are secure. For more information, see the
documentation that came with the print server.
b Access the EWS.
Can you open the EWS?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 6.
Step 6
a Check if the web proxy servers are disabled.
Note: If the servers are disabled, then contact your
administrator.
b Access the EWS.
Can you open the EWS?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Cannot connect the printer to the WiFi network
Action Yes No
Step 1
Make sure that Active Adapter is set to Auto.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Network
Overview > Active Adapter > Auto.
Can the printer connect to the WiFi network?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Check if the correct WiFi network is selected.
Note: Some routers may share the default SSID.
Are you connecting to the correct WiFi network?
Go to step 4. Go to step 3.
Step 3
Connect to the correct WiFi network. For more information, see
“Connecting the printer to a WiFi network” on page 97.
Can the printer connect to the WiFi network?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 4.
Troubleshoot a problem 317
background
Action Yes No
Step 4
Check the wireless security mode.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Wireless
> Wireless Security Mode.
Is the correct wireless security mode selected?
Go to step 6. Go to step 5.
Step 5
Select the correct wireless security mode.
Can the printer connect to the WiFi network?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 6.
Step 6
Make sure that you entered the correct network password.
Note: Take note of the spaces, numbers, and capitalization in the
password.
Can the printer connect to the WiFi network?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Hardware options problems
Cannot detect internal option
Action Yes No
Step 1
Turn o the printer, wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn on the
printer.
Does the printer detect the internal option?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Print the Menu Settings Page, and then check if the internal option
appears in the Installed Features list.
Is the internal option listed?
Go to step 4. Go to step 3.
Troubleshoot a problem 318
background
Action Yes No
Step 3
Check if the internal option is installed properly into the controller
board.
a Turn o the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the
electrical outlet.
b Make sure that the internal option is installed into the
appropriate connector on the controller board.
c Connect the power cord to the electrical outlet, and then turn
on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire
or electrical shock, connect the power cord to an
appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet
that is near the product and easily accessible.
Does the printer detect the internal option?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 4.
Step 4
a Check if the internal option is available in the print driver.
Note: If necessary, manually add the internal option in the
print driver to make it available for print jobs. For more
information, see
Adding available options in the print driver”
on page 56.
b Print the document.
Does the printer detect the internal option?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Internal solutions port does not operate correctly
Action Yes No
Step 1
Print a menu settings page, and then check if the internal solutions
port (ISP) appears in the Installed Features list.
Is the ISP listed in the Installed Features list?
Go to step 3. Go to step 2.
Step 2
Remove, and then install the ISP. For more information, see
“Installing an internal solutions port” on page 72.
Note: Use a supported ISP.
Does the ISP operate correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Troubleshoot a problem 319
background
Action Yes No
Step 3
Check the cable and the ISP connection.
a Use the correct cable, and then make sure that it is securely
connected to the ISP.
b Check if the ISP solution interface cable is securely connected
into the receptacle of the controller board.
Does the ISP operate correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Parallel or serial interface card does not operate correctly
Action Yes No
Step 1
Print a menu settings page, and then check if the parallel or serial
interface card appears in the Installed Features list.
Is the parallel or serial interface card listed in the Installed Features
list?
Go to step 3. Go to step 2.
Step 2
Remove, and then install the parallel or serial interface card.
For more information, see
“Installing an internal solutions port” on
page 72.
Does the parallel or serial interface card operate correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Check the connection between the cable and the parallel or serial
interface card.
Does the parallel or serial interface card operate correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Defective flash detected
Try one or more of the following:
Replace the defective intelligent storage drive.
From the home screen, touch Continue to ignore the message and continue printing.
Cancel the current print job.
Not enough free space in
flash
memory for resources
Try one or more of the following:
Tou ch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.
Delete fonts, macros, and other data stored in the flash memory.
Install a hard disk.
Troubleshoot a problem 320
background
Note: Downloaded fonts and macros that are not previously stored in the flash memory are deleted.
Red light on the convenience stapler
Try one or more of the following:
Close the staple access door.
Remove the loose staples.
Note: After removing loose staples, two priming cycles are required before stapling. Insert a stack of
paper into the stapler three times. The stapling starts at the third insertion.
Replace the staple cartridge.
Issues with supplies
Replace cartridge, printer region mismatch
To correct this problem, purchase a cartridge with the correct region that matches the printer region, or
purchase a worldwide cartridge.
The first number in the message after 42 indicates the region of the printer.
The second number in the message after 42 indicates the region of the cartridge.
Printer and toner cartridge regions
Region Numeric code
Worldwide or Undefined region 0
North America (United States, Canada) 1
European Economic Area, Western Europe, Nordic countries, Switzerland 2
Asia Pacific 3
Latin America 4
Rest of Europe, Middle East, Africa 5
Australia, New Zealand 6
Invalid region 9
Note: To
find
the region settings of the printer and toner cartridge, print the print quality test pages.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Refilled regular [color] cartridge
The printer has detected a Lexmark Regular cartridge that has been refilled with nongenuine toner by a
party other than Lexmark.
Select OK to continue.
Troubleshoot a problem 321
background
All printer component life indicators are designed to function with Lexmark supplies and parts and may
deliver unpredictable results when using supplies or parts in your Lexmark printer that are remanufactured
by parties other than Lexmark.
For more information, see the printer statement of limited warranty.
NonLexmark supply
The printer has detected a nonLexmark supply or part installed in the printer.
Your Lexmark printer is designed to function best with genuine Lexmark supplies and parts. Use of third-
party supplies or parts may aect the performance, reliability, or life of the printer and its imaging
components.
All life indicators are designed to function with Lexmark supplies and parts and may deliver unpredictable
results if third-party supplies or parts are used. Imaging component usage beyond the intended life may
damage your Lexmark printer or associated components.
Warning—Potential Damage: Use of third-party supplies or parts can aect warranty coverage.
Damage caused by the use of third-party supplies or parts may not be covered by the warranty.
To accept any and all of these risks and to proceed with the use of non-genuine supplies or parts in your
printer, touch and hold the error message on the display using two fingers for 15 seconds. When a
confirmation dialog box appears, touch Continue.
If you do not want to accept these risks, then remove the third-party supply or part from your printer and
install a genuine Lexmark supply or part. For more information, see
“Using genuine Lexmark parts and
supplies” on page 208.
If the printer does not print after clearing the error message, then reset the supply usage counter.
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Maintenance > Configuration Menu > Supply Usage
And Counters.
2 Select the part or supply that you want to reset, and then touch Start.
3 Read the warning message, and then touch Continue.
4 Using two fingers, touch the display for 15 seconds to clear the message.
Note: If you are unable to reset the supply usage counters, then return the supply item to the place of
purchase.
Troubleshoot a problem 322
background
Paper feed problems
Envelope seals when printing
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Use an envelope that has been stored in a dry environment.
Note: Printing on envelopes with high moisture content can
seal the flaps.
b Send the print job.
Does the envelope seal when printing?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Make sure that paper type is set to Envelope.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper > Tray
Configuration > Paper Size/Type.
b Send the print job.
Does the envelope seal when printing?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Collated printing does not work
Action Yes No
Step 1
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Layout >
Collate.
b Tou c h On [1,2,1,2,1,2].
c Print the document.
Is the document collated correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
a From the document that you are trying to print, open the Print
dialog box, and then select Collate.
b Print the document.
Is the document collated correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
a Reduce the number of pages to print.
b Print the document.
Are the pages collated correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshoot a problem 323
background
Tray linking does not work
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Check if the trays contain the same paper size and paper type.
b Check if the paper guides are positioned correctly.
c Print the document.
Do the trays link correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper > Tray
Configuration > Paper Size/Type.
b Set the paper size and paper type to match the paper loaded
in the linked trays.
c Print the document.
Do the trays link correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
a Make sure that Tray Linking is set to Automatic. For more
information, see
“Linking trays” on page 54.
b Print the document.
Do the trays link correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Paper frequently jams
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Remove the tray.
b Check if paper is loaded correctly.
Notes:
Make sure that the paper guides are positioned correctly.
Make sure that the stack height is below the maximum
paper fill indicator.
Make sure to print on recommended paper size and type.
c Insert the tray.
d Print the document.
Do paper jams occur frequently?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 324
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper > Tray
Configuration > Paper Size/Type.
b Set the correct paper size and type.
c Print the document.
Do paper jams occur frequently?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you are ready to use it.
b Print the document.
Do paper jams occur frequently?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Jammed pages are not reprinted
Action Yes No
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Device >
Notifications
> Jam Content Recovery.
b In the Jam Recovery menu, touch On or Auto.
c Print the document.
Are the jammed pages reprinted?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
E-mailing problems
Disabling the “SMTP server not set up” error message
From the control panel, navigate to Settings > Email > Email Setup > Disable “SMTP Server not set up” error
> On.
To prevent the error from happening again, do one or more of the following:
Update the printer firmware. For more information, see the “Updating firmware” section.
Configure the email SMTP settings. For more information, see “Configuring the email SMTP settings” on
page 40.
Troubleshoot a problem 325
background
Cannot send emails
Action Yes No
Step 1
Make sure that the email SMTP settings are configured correctly.
For more information, see
“Configuring the email SMTP settings
on page 40.
Can you send an email?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Make sure that you are using the correct password. Depending on
your email service provider, use your account password, app
password, or authentication password. For more information, see
“Configuring
the email SMTP settings” on page 40.
Can you send an email?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Make sure that the printer is connected to a network and that the
network is connected to the Internet.
Can you send an email?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Faxing problems
Caller ID is not shown
Note: These instructions apply only to printers that support analog fax. For more information, see the Setting
up the printer to fax section.
Action Yes No
Enable caller ID.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > Fax
Receive Settings > Admin Controls > Enable Caller ID.
Does the caller ID appear?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshoot a problem 326
background
Cannot send or receive faxes using analog fax
Action Yes No
Step 1
Resolve any error messages that appear on the display.
Can you send or receive a fax?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Make sure that the cable connections for the following equipment
are secure:
Telephone
Handset
Answering machine
Can you send or receive a fax?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Check for a dial tone.
Call the fax number to check if it is working properly.
If you are using the On Hook Dial feature, then turn up the
volume to check if you hear a dial tone.
Can you hear a dial tone?
Go to step 5. Go to step 4.
Step 4
Check the telephone wall jack.
a Connect the analog telephone directly to the wall jack.
b Listen for a dial tone.
c If you do not hear a dial tone, then use a
dierent
telephone
cable.
d If you still do not hear a dial tone, then connect the analog
telephone to a
dierent
wall jack.
e If you hear a dial tone, then connect the printer to that wall jack.
Can you send or receive a fax?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 5.
Troubleshoot a problem 327
background
Action Yes No
Step 5
Check if the printer is connected to an analog phone service or to
the correct digital connector.
If you are using an Integrated Services for Digital Network
(ISDN) telephone service, then connect to an analog telephone
port of an ISDN terminal adapter. For more information, contact
your ISDN provider.
If you are using DSL, then connect to a DSL filter or router that
supports analog use. For more information, contact your DSL
provider.
If you are using a private branch exchange (PBX) telephone
service, then make sure that you are connecting to an analog
connection on the PBX. If none exists, then consider installing
an analog telephone line for the fax machine.
Can you send or receive a fax?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 6.
Step 6
Temporarily disconnect other equipment and disable other
telephone services.
a Disconnect other equipment (such as answering machines,
computers, modems, or telephone line splitters) between the
printer and the telephone line.
b Disable call waiting and voice mail. For more information,
contact your telephone company.
Can you send or receive a fax?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 7.
Step 7
Scan the original document one page at a time.
a Dial the fax number.
b Scan the document.
Can you send or receive a fax?
The problem is
solved.
Contact customer
support.
Troubleshoot a problem 328
background
Can receive but not send faxes using analog fax
Action Yes No
Step 1
Load an original document properly into the ADF tray or on the
scanner glass.
Can you send faxes?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Set up the shortcut number properly.
Check if the shortcut number is set for the telephone number
that you want to dial.
Dial the telephone number manually.
Can you send faxes?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Can send but not receive faxes using analog fax
Action Yes No
Step 1
Make sure that the paper source is not empty.
Can you receive faxes?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Check the ring count delay settings.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > Fax
Receive Settings > Rings to Answer.
Can you receive faxes?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
If the printer is printing blank pages, then see
“Blank or white
pages” on page 273.
Can you receive faxes?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Cannot set up etherFAX
Action Yes No
Step 1
Check the printer connectivity.
a Print the Network Setup Page. From the home screen, touch
Settings > Reports > Network > Network Setup Page.
b Check the network status.
Is the printer connected to the network?
Go to step 3. Go to step 2.
Troubleshoot a problem 329
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
Make sure that the printer is connected to a network and that the
network is connected to the Internet.
Can you set up etherFAX?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Make sure that etherFAX is set up correctly. For more information,
see
“Setting up the fax function using etherFAX” on page 35.
Can you set up etherFAX?
The problem is
solved.
Go to
https://www.etherfa
x.net/lexmark.
Cannot send or receive faxes using etherFAX
Action Yes No
Step 1
Make sure that the printer is connected to a network and that the
network is connected to the Internet.
Can you send or receive faxes using etherFAX?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Make sure that etherFAX is set up correctly.
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Fax > Fax Setup >
General Fax Settings.
b Make sure that you have the correct fax number.
c Make sure that Fax Transport is set to etherFAX.
Notes:
This menu shows up only when more than one fax
transport is available.
If the printer only has etherFAX installed, then it is
automatically configured.
Can you send or receive faxes using etherFAX?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Split large documents into smaller file sizes.
Can you send or receive faxes using etherFAX?
The problem is
solved.
Go to
https://www.etherfa
x.net/lexmark.
Troubleshoot a problem 330
background
Poor fax print quality
Action Yes No
Step 1
Make sure that there are no print quality defects.
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Troubleshooting >
Print Quality Test Pages.
b Correct any print quality defects. For more information, see
“Print quality is poor” on page 273.
Is the fax print quality satisfactory?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
If you are using an analog fax, then decrease the incoming fax
transmission speed.
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > Fax
Receive Settings > Admin Controls.
b In the Max Speed menu, select a lower transmission speed.
Is the fax print quality satisfactory?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Missing information on the fax cover page
Action No Yes
a Turn
o
the printer, wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn on
the printer.
b Send or retrieve the fax.
Is there missing information on the fax cover page?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Cannot send the fax cover page from the computer
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Make sure that the print driver is updated. For more information,
see
“Installing the printer software” on page 54.
b Send the fax.
Can you send the fax cover page?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Troubleshoot a problem 331
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a From the document that you are trying to fax, open the Print
dialog.
b Select the printer, and then click Properties, Preferences,
Options, or Setup.
c Click Fax, and then clear the Always display settings prior to
faxing setting.
d Send the fax.
Can you send the fax cover page?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Scanning problems
Cannot scan to a computer
Action Yes No
Step 1
Perform a copy job.
Is the copy job successful?
Go to step 3. Go to step 2.
Step 2
a Turn o the printer, wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn it
back on.
b Scan the document.
Can you scan the document to a computer?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Check the printer connectivity.
a Print the Network Setup Page. From the home screen, touch
Settings > Reports > Network > Network Setup Page.
b Check the network status.
Is the printer connected to the network?
Go to step 5. Go to step 4.
Step 4
a Connect the printer to the network.
b Scan the document.
Can you scan the document to a computer?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 5.
Troubleshoot a problem 332
background
Action Yes No
Step 5
a Make sure that the printer and the computer are connected to
the same network.
b Scan the document.
Can you scan the document to a computer?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Cannot scan to a network folder
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Create a network folder shortcut.
b Scan a document using the shortcut. For more information, see
“Scanning to a network folder” on page 119.
Can you scan a document and save it to a network folder?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Make sure that the network folder path and format are correct. For
example, //server_hostname/foldername/path, where
server_hostname is a fully qualified domain (FQDN) or IP
address.
Is the network folder path and format correct?
Go to step 3. Go to step 4.
Step 3
Make sure that you have a write access permission to the network
folder.
Can you scan a document and save it to a network folder?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 4.
Troubleshoot a problem 333
background
Action Yes No
Step 4
Update the network folder shortcut.
a Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in
the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the home screen. The IP
address appears as four sets of numbers separated by
periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it
to load the web page correctly.
b Click Shortcuts, and then select a shortcut.
Note: If you have multiple shortcut types, then select
Network Folder.
c In the Share Path field, type the network folder path.
Notes:
If your share path is \\server_hostname
\foldername\path, then
type //server_hostname/foldername/path.
Make sure that you use forward slashes when typing the
share path.
d From the Authentication menu, select your authentication
method.
Note: If Authentication is set to “Use assigned username and
password,” then in the User Name and Password fields, type
your credentials.
e Click Save.
Can you scan a document and save it to a network folder?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 5.
Step 5
Make sure that the printer and the network folder are connected
to the same network.
Can you scan a document and save it to a network folder?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Partial copies of document or photo
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Make sure that the document or photo is loaded facedown on
the upper left corner of the scanner glass.
b Copy the document or photo.
Is the document or photo copied correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Troubleshoot a problem 334
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a Match the paper size setting and the paper loaded in the tray.
b Copy the document or photo.
Is the document or photo copied correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Poor copy quality
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Clean the scanner glass and the ADF glass with a damp, soft,
lintfree cloth. If your printer has a second ADF glass inside the
ADF, then also clean that glass.
For more information, see
“Cleaning the scanner” on page
250.
b Make sure that the document or photo is loaded facedown on
the upper left corner of the scanner glass.
c Copy the document or photo.
Is the copy quality satisfactory?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
a Check the quality of the original document or photo.
b Adjust the scan quality settings.
c Copy the document or photo.
Is the copy quality satisfactory?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Vertical dark streaks on output when scanning from the ADF
Troubleshoot a problem 335
background
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Open the scanner cover.
b Using a damp, soft, lintfree cloth, wipe the ADF glass and the
white underside of the scanner cover.
c Close the scanner cover.
Do vertical streaks appear on scanned documents?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Open the ADF cover.
b Using a damp, soft, lintfree cloth, wipe the ADF glass and the
white underside of the ADF cover.
c Close the ADF cover.
Do vertical streaks appear on scanned documents?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Jagged image or text when scanning from the ADF
Action Yes No
a Load 50 sheets of clean, plain paper into the ADF.
Note: The plain paper helps clean or remove dust and other
coating from the ADF feed rollers.
b From the home screen, touch .
c Load an original document into the ADF.
d Scan the document.
Do jagged images or texts appear on the output?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 336
background
Scan job was not successful
Action Yes No
Step 1
Check the cable connections.
a Make sure that the Ethernet or USB cable is securely connected
to the computer and the printer.
b Resend the scan job.
Is the scan job successful?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Check the file you want to scan.
a Make sure that the file name is not already used in the
destination folder.
b Make sure that the document or photo you want to scan is not
open in another application.
c Resend the scan job.
Is the scan job successful?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
a Make sure that the Append time stamp or the Overwrite
existing file check box is selected in the destination
configuration
settings.
b Resend the scan job.
Is the scan job successful?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Scanner does not close
Action Yes No
Remove obstructions that keep the scanner cover open.
Did the scanner cover close correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Scanning takes too long or freezes the computer
Action Yes No
Close all applications that are interfering with the scan.
Does scanning take too long or freeze the computer?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 337
background
Scanner does not respond
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Check if the power cord is connected properly to the printer
and the electrical outlet.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of
fire
or electrical shock, connect the power cord to an
appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet
that is near the product and easily accessible.
b Copy or scan the document.
Is the scanner responding?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
a Check if the printer is turned on.
b Resolve any error messages that appear on the display.
c Copy or scan the document.
Is the scanner responding?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
a Turn o the printer, wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn the
printer on.
b Copy or scan the document.
Is the scanner responding?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Adjusting scanner registration
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Maintenance > Configuration Menu > Scanner
Configuration > Scanner Manual Registration.
2 In the Print Quick Test menu, touch Start.
3 Place the Print Quick Test page on the scanner glass, and then touch Flatbed Registration.
4 In the Copy Quick Test menu, touch Start.
5 Compare the Copy Quick Test page with the original document.
Note: If the margins of the test page are
dierent
from the original document, then adjust Left Margin and
Top Margin.
6 Repeat step 4 and step 5 until the margins of the Copy Quick Test page closely match the original document.
Adjusting ADF registration
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Maintenance > Configuration Menu > Scanner
Configuration > Scanner Manual Registration.
2 In the Print Quick Test menu, touch Start.
Troubleshoot a problem 338
background
3 Place the Print Quick Test page on the ADF tray.
4 Touch Front ADF Registration or Rear ADF Registration.
Notes:
To align Front ADF Registration, place the test page faceup, short edge
first
into the ADF.
To align Rear ADF Registration, place the test page facedown, short edge
first
into the ADF.
5 In the Copy Quick Test menu, touch Start.
6 Compare the Copy Quick Test page with the original document.
Note: If the margins of the test page are
dierent
from the original document, then adjust Horizontal
Adjust and Top Margin.
7 Repeat step 5 and step 6 until the margins of the Copy Quick Test page closely match the original document.
Color quality problems
Modifying the colors in printed output
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality > Advanced Imaging > Color Correction.
2 In the Color Correction menu, touch Manual > Color Correction Content.
3 Choose the appropriate color conversion setting.
Object type Color conversion tables
RGB Image
RGB Text
RGB Graphics
Vivid—Produces brighter, more saturated colors and may be
applied to all incoming color formats.
sRGB Display—Produces an output that approximates the colors
shown on a computer monitor. Black toner usage is optimized for
printing photographs.
DisplayTrue Black—Produces an output that approximates the
colors shown on a computer monitor. This setting uses only black
toner to create all levels of neutral gray.
sRGB Vivid—Provides an increased color saturation for the sRGB
Display color correction. Black toner usage is optimized for
printing business graphics.
O
CMYK Image
CMYK Text
CMYK Graphics
US CMYK—Applies color correction to approximate the
Specifications for Web Oset Publishing (SWOP) color output.
Euro CMYK—Applies color correction to approximate Euroscale
color output.
Vivid CMYK—Increases the color saturation of the US CMYK color
correction setting.
O
Troubleshoot a problem 339
background
FAQ about color printing
What is RGB color?
RGB color is a method of describing colors by indicating the amount of red, green, or blue used to produce
a certain color. Red, green, and blue light can be added in various amounts to produce a large range of colors
observed in nature. Computer screens, scanners, and digital cameras use this method to display colors.
What is CMYK color?
CMYK color is a method of describing colors by indicating the amount of cyan, magenta, yellow, and black
used to reproduce a particular color. Cyan, magenta, yellow, and black inks or toners can be printed in various
amounts to produce a large range of colors observed in nature. Printing presses, inkjet printers, and color
laser printers create colors in this manner.
How is color specified in a document to be printed?
Software programs are used to specify and modify the document color using RGB or CMYK color
combinations. For more information, see the software program Help topics.
How does the printer know what color to print?
When printing a document, information describing the type and color of each object is sent to the printer and
is passed through color conversion tables. Color is translated into the appropriate amounts of cyan, magenta,
yellow, and black toner used to produce the color you want. The object information determines the application
of color conversion tables. For example, it is possible to apply one type of color conversion table to text while
applying a dierent color conversion table to photographic images.
What is manual color correction?
When manual color correction is enabled, the printer employs userselected color conversion tables to
process objects. Manual color correction settings are specific to the type of object being printed (text,
graphics, or images). It is also specific to how the color of the object is specified in the software program
(RGB or CMYK combinations). To apply a dierent color conversion table manually, see “Modifying the colors
in printed output” on page 339.
If the software program does not specify colors with RGB or CMYK combinations, then manual color correction
is not useful. It is also not eective if the software program or the computer operating system controls the
adjustment of colors. In most situations, setting the Color Correction to Auto generates preferred colors for
the documents.
How can I match a particular color (such as a corporate logo)?
From the printer Quality menu, nine types of Color Samples sets are available. These sets are also available
from the Color Samples page of the Embedded Web Server. Selecting any sample set generates
multiplepage prints consisting of hundreds of colored boxes. Each box contains a CMYK or RGB combination,
depending on the table selected. The observed color of each box is obtained by passing the CMYK or RGB
combination labeled on the box through the selected color conversion table.
By examining Color Samples sets, you can identify the box with color closest to the color being matched.
The color combination labeled on the box can then be used for modifying the color of the object in a software
program. For more information, see the software program Help topics. Manual color correction may be
necessary to use the selected color conversion table for the particular object.
Selecting which Color Samples set to use for a particular colormatching problem depends on:
The Color Correction setting being used (Auto, O, or Manual)
The type of object being printed (text, graphics, or images)
How the color of the object is specified in the software program (RGB or CMYK combinations)
Troubleshoot a problem 340
background
If the software program does not specify colors with RGB or CMYK combinations, then the Color Samples
pages are not useful. Additionally, some software programs adjust the RGB or CMYK combinations specified
in the program through color management. In these situations, the printed color may not be an exact match
of the Color Samples pages.
The print appears tinted
Action Yes No
Step 1
Perform Color Adjust.
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality >
Advanced Imaging > Color Adjust.
b Print the document.
Does the print appear tinted?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
Perform Color Balance.
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality >
Advanced Imaging > Color Balance.
b Adjust the settings.
c Print the document.
Does the print appear tinted?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Contacting customer support
Before contacting customer support, make sure to have the following information:
Printer problem
Error message
Printer model type and serial number
Go to
http://support.lexmark.com to receive email or chat support, or browse through the library of manuals,
support documentation, drivers, and other downloads.
Technical support via telephone is also available. In the U.S. or Canada, call 1-800-539-6275. For other countries
or regions, go to
http://support.lexmark.com.
Troubleshoot a problem 341
background
Recycle and dispose
Recycling Lexmark products
To return Lexmark products for recycling:
1 Go to www.lexmark.com/recycle.
2 Select the product you want to recycle.
Note: Printer supplies and hardware not listed in the Lexmark Collection and Recycling Program may be
recycled through your local recycling center.
Recycling Lexmark packaging
Lexmark continually strives to minimize packaging. Less packaging helps to ensure that Lexmark printers are
transported in the most
ecient
and environmentally sensitive manner and that there is less packaging to
dispose of. These eciencies result in fewer greenhouse emissions, energy savings, and natural resource
savings. Lexmark also oers recycling of packaging components in some countries or regions. For more
information, go to
www.lexmark.com/recycle, and then choose your country or region. Information on available
packaging recycling programs is included with the information on product recycling.
Lexmark cartons are 100% recyclable where corrugated recycling facilities exist. Facilities may not exist in your
area.
The foam used in Lexmark packaging is recyclable where foam recycling facilities exist. Facilities may not exist
in your area.
When you return a cartridge to Lexmark, you can reuse the box that the cartridge came in. Lexmark recycles
the box.
Recycle and dispose 342
background
Notices
Product information
Product name:
Lexmark CX730de, Lexmark CX735adse, Lexmark CX737adzse, Lexmark XC4342, Lexmark XC4352 MFPs
Machine type:
7530
Models:
236, 239, 678, 679, 878
Edition notice
July 2024
The following paragraph does not apply to any country where such provisions are inconsistent with local
law: LEXMARK INTERNATIONAL, INC., PROVIDES THIS PUBLICATION “AS IS” WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY
KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. Some states do not allow disclaimer of
express or implied warranties in certain transactions; therefore, this statement may not apply to you.
This publication could include technical inaccuracies or typographical errors. Changes are periodically made
to the information herein; these changes will be incorporated in later editions. Improvements or changes in the
products or the programs described may be made at any time.
References in this publication to products, programs, or services do not imply that the manufacturer intends to
make these available in all countries in which it operates. Any reference to a product, program, or service is
not intended to state or imply that only that product, program, or service may be used. Any functionally
equivalent product, program, or service that does not infringe any existing intellectual property right may be
used instead. Evaluation and
verification
of operation in conjunction with other products, programs, or services,
except those expressly designated by the manufacturer, are the user’s responsibility.
For Lexmark technical support, go to
http://support.lexmark.com.
For information on Lexmark's privacy policy governing the use of this product, go to
www.lexmark.com/privacy.
For information on supplies and downloads, go to
www.lexmark.com.
© 2022 Lexmark International, Inc.
All rights reserved.
GOVERNMENT END USERS
The Software Program and any related documentation are "Commercial Items," as that term is
defined
in 48
C.F.R. 2.101, "Computer Software" and "Commercial Computer Software Documentation," as such terms are
used in 48 C.F.R. 12.212 or 48 C.F.R. 227.7202, as applicable. Consistent with 48 C.F.R. 12.212 or 48 C.F.R.
227.7202-1 through 227.7207-4, as applicable, the Commercial Computer Software and Commercial Software
Notices 343
background
Documentation are licensed to the U.S. Government end users (a) only as Commercial Items and (b) with only
those rights as are granted to all other end users pursuant to the terms and conditions herein.
Trademarks
Lexmark, the Lexmark logo, and MarkNet are trademarks or registered trademarks of Lexmark International,
Inc. in the United States and/or other countries.
Gmail, Android, Google Play, and Google Chrome are trademarks of Google LLC.
Macintosh, macOS, Safari, and AirPrint are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.
App Store and iCloud are service marks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. Use of the
Works with Apple badge means that an accessory has been designed to work specifically with the technology
identified in the badge and has been certified by the developer to meet Apple performance standards.
Microsoft, Internet Explorer, Microsoft 365, Microsoft Edge, Outlook, and Windows are trademarks of the
Microsoft group of companies.
The Mopria® word mark is a registered and/or unregistered trademark of Mopria Alliance, Inc. in the United
States and other countries. Unauthorized use is strictly prohibited.
PCL® is a registered trademark of the Hewlett-Packard Company. PCL is Hewlett-Packard Company’s
designation of a set of printer commands (language) and functions included in its printer products. This printer
is intended to be compatible with the PCL language. This means the printer recognizes PCL commands used
in various application programs, and that the printer emulates the functions corresponding to the commands.
PostScript is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United States and/or other countries.
Wi-Fi® and Wi-Fi Direct® are registered trademarks of Wi-Fi Alliance®.
All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners.
Licensing notices
All licensing notices associated with this product can be viewed from the CD:\NOTICES directory of the
installation software CD.
Noise emission levels
The following measurements were made in accordance with ISO 7779 and reported in conformance with ISO
9296.
Note: Some modes may not apply to your product.
1-meter average sound pressure, dBA
Printing One-sided: 52 (CX730de, XC4342);
53 (CX735, CX737, XC4352)
Two-sided: 53 (CX730, XC4342); 55
(CX735, CX737, XC4352)
Scanning 51
Notices 344
background
1-meter average sound pressure, dBA
Copying Mono: 55 (CX730, XC4342); 56
(CX735, CX737, XC4352)
Color: 51 (CX730, XC4342); 52
(CX735, CX737, XC4352)
Ready 14
Values are subject to change. See www.lexmark.com for current values.
Waste from Electrical and Electronic Equipment (WEEE) directive
The WEEE logo
signifies
specific
recycling programs and procedures for electronic products in countries of the
European Union. We encourage the recycling of our products.
If you have further questions about recycling options, visit the Lexmark Web site at
www.lexmark.com for your
local sales oce phone number.
India E-Waste notice
This product including components, consumables, parts and spares complies with the “India E-Waste Rules”
and prohibits use of lead, mercury, hexavalent chromium, polybrominated biphenyls or polybrominated
diphenyl ethers in concentrations exceeding 0.1% by weight and 0.01% by weight for cadmium, except for the
exemption set in the Rule.
Notices 345
background
Lithiumion rechargeable battery
This product may contain a coin-cell, lithium-ion rechargeable battery, which should only be removed by a
trained technician. Crossed-out wheelie bin means the product should not be discarded as unsorted waste but
must be sent to separate collection facilities for recovery and recycling. In the event the battery is removed, do
not dispose of the battery in your household waste. There may be separate collection systems for batteries in
your local community, such as a battery-recycling
drop-o
location. The separate collection of waste batteries
assures appropriate treatment of waste including reuse and recycling and prevents any potential negative
eects
on human health and environment. Please responsibly dispose of the batteries.
Regulation (EU) 2023/1542
Regulation (EU) 2023/1542
This product may contain a coin-cell lithium rechargeable battery. This battery complies with Regulation (EU)
2023/1542. Compliance is indicated by the CE marking:
This product may contain one of the following coin-cell batteries:
Battery identification: Seiko Model Number MS621FE
Manufacturer: Seiko Instruments Inc.
Manufacturer address: 8, Nakase 1-chome, Mihama-ku, Chiba-shi, Chiba 261-8507, Japan
Battery identification: Panasonic Model Number ML621
Manufacturer: Panasonic Energy Co., Ltd.
Manufacturer address: 1-1 Matsushita-cho, Moriguchi City, Osaka 570-8511, Japan
Battery identification: FDK Model Number ML621
Manufacturer: FDK Corporation
Manufacturer address: Shibaura Crystal Shinagawa, 1-6-41 Konan, Minato-ku, Tokyo 108-8212 Japan
Environmental labeling for packaging
Per Commission Regulation Decision 97/129/EC Legislative Decree 152/2006, the product packaging may
contain one or more of the following symbols.
Notices 346
background
This symbol indicates that the packaging may contain corrugated fiberboard.
This symbol indicates that the packaging may contain non-corrugated fiberboard.
This symbol indicates that the packaging may contain paper.
For more information, go to www.lexmark.com/recycle, and then choose your country or region. Information
on available packaging recycling programs is included with the information on product recycling.
Product disposal
Do not dispose of the printer or supplies in the same manner as normal household waste. Consult your local
authorities for disposal and recycling options.
Returning Lexmark cartridges for reuse or recycling
The Lexmark Cartridge Collection Program allows you to return used cartridges for free to Lexmark for reuse
or recycling. One hundred percent of the empty cartridges returned to Lexmark are either reused or
demanufactured for recycling. The boxes used to return the cartridges are also recycled.
To return Lexmark cartridges for reuse or recycling, do the following:
1 Go to www.lexmark.com/recycle.
2 Select your country or region.
3 Select Lexmark Cartridge Collection Program.
4 Follow the instructions on the screen.
Static sensitivity notice
Notices 347
background
Static sensitivity notice
This symbol identifies static-sensitive parts. Do not touch the areas near these symbols without first touching
a metal surface in an area away from the symbol.
To prevent damage from electrostatic discharge when performing maintenance tasks such as clearing paper
jams or replacing supplies, touch any exposed metal frame of the printer before accessing or touching interior
areas of the printer even if the symbol is not present.
ENERGY STAR
Any Lexmark product bearing the ENERGY STAR
®
emblem on the product or on a start-up screen is
certified
to
comply with Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) ENERGY STAR requirements as of the date of manufacture.
Temperature information
Operating temperature and relative humidity 10 to 32.2°C (50 to 90°F) and 15 to 80% RH
15.6 to 32.2°C (60 to 90°F) and 8 to 80% RH
Maximum wet-bulb temperature
2
: 22.8°C (73°F)
Non-condensing environment
Printer / cartridge / imaging unit long-
term storage
1
15.6 to 32.2°C (60 to 90°F) and 8 to 80% RH
Maximum wet-bulb temperature
2
: 22.8°C (73°F)
Printer / cartridge / imaging unit short-term
shipping
-40 to 40°C (-40 to 104°F)
1
Supplies shelf life is approximately 2 years. This is based on storage in a standard oce environment at 22°C (72°F)
and 45% humidity.
2
Wet-bulb temperature is determined by the air temperature and the relative humidity.
Laser notice
The printer is certified in the U.S. to conform to the requirements of DHHS 21 CFR, Chapter I, Subchapter J for
Class I (1) laser products, and elsewhere is
certified
as a Class 1 consumer laser product conforming to the
requirements of IEC 60825-1:2014, EN 60825-1:2014+A11:2021, and EN 50689:2021.
Notices 348
background
Class I laser products are not considered to be hazardous. The laser system and printer are designed so there
is never any human access to laser radiation above a Class I level during normal operation, user maintenance,
or prescribed service conditions. The printer has a non-serviceable printhead assembly that contains a laser
with the following specifications:
Class: IIIb (3b) AlGaAs
Nominal output power (milliwatts): 12
Wavelength (nanometers): 770–800
Power consumption
Product power consumption
The following table documents the power consumption characteristics of the product.
Note: Some modes may not apply to your product.
Mode Description Power consumption (Watts)
Printing The product is generating hardcopy output from
electronic inputs.
One-sided: 630 (CX730, XC4342); 760
(CX735, CX737, XC4352)
Two-sided: 520 (CX730, XC4342); 640
(CX735, CX737, XC4352)
Copy The product is generating hardcopy output from
hardcopy original documents.
640 (CX730, XC4342); 800 (CX735, CX737,
XC4352)
Scan The product is scanning hardcopy documents. 44.5 (CX730, XC4342); 45.0 (CX735, CX737,
XC4352)
Ready The product is waiting for a print job. 31.5 (CX730, XC4342); 32.0 (CX735, CX737,
XC4352)
Sleep Mode The product is in a highlevel energysaving mode. 1.0 (CX730, XC4342); 1.2 (CX735, CX737,
XC4352)
Hibernate The product is in a lowlevel energysaving mode. 0.1
O The product is plugged into an electrical outlet, but the
power switch is turned o.
0.1
The power consumption levels listed in the previous table represent time-averaged measurements.
Instantaneous power draws may be substantially higher than the average.
Values are subject to change. See
www.lexmark.com for current values.
Sleep Mode
This product is designed with an energy-saving mode called Sleep Mode. The Sleep Mode saves energy by
lowering power consumption during extended periods of inactivity. The Sleep Mode is automatically engaged
after this product is not used for a
specified
period of time, called the Sleep Mode Timeout.
Factory default Sleep Mode Timeout for this product (in minutes): 15
Notices 349
background
By using the configuration menus, the Sleep Mode Timeout can be modified between 1 minute and 120 minutes,
or between 1 minute and 114 minutes, depending on the printer model. If the printer speed is less than or equal
to 30 pages per minute, then you can set the timeout only up to 60 minutes or 54 minutes, depending on the
printer model. Setting the Sleep Mode Timeout to a low value reduces energy consumption, but may increase
the response time of the product. Setting the Sleep Mode Timeout to a high value maintains a fast response,
but uses more energy.
Some models support a Deep Sleep Mode, which further reduces power consumption after longer periods of
inactivity.
Hibernate Mode
This product is designed with an ultralow power operating mode called Hibernate mode. When operating in
Hibernate Mode, all other systems and devices are powered down safely.
The Hibernate mode can be entered in any of the following methods:
Using the Hibernate Timeout
Using the Schedule Power modes
Factory default Hibernate Timeout for this product in all countries or regions 3 days
The amount of time the printer waits after a job is printed before it enters Hibernate mode can be
modified
between one hour and one month.
Notes on EPEAT-registered imaging equipment products:
Standby power level occurs in Hibernate or O mode.
The product shall automatically power down to a standby power level of ≤ 1 W. The auto standby function
(Hibernate or O) shall be enabled at product shipment.
O mode
If this product has an o mode which still consumes a small amount of power, then to completely stop product
power consumption, disconnect the power supply cord from the electrical outlet.
Total energy usage
Total energy usage
It is sometimes helpful to estimate the total product energy usage. Since power consumption claims are
provided in power units of Watts, the power consumption should be multiplied by the time the product spends
in each mode in order to calculate energy usage. The total product energy usage is the sum of each mode's
energy usage.
Applicability of Regulation (EU) 2019/2015 and (EU) 2019/2020
Per Commission Regulation (EU) 2019/2015 and (EU) 2019/2020, the light source contained within this product
or its component is intended to be used for Image Capture or Image Projection only, and is not intended for
use in other applications.
Notices 350
background
Thailand NBTC technical standards conformity statement
คําประกาศเรื่องการเปนไปตามมาตรฐานทางเทคนคของ
กสทช
.
ประเทศไทย
This telecommunication equipment conforms to the technical standards or requirements of NBTC.
เครื่องโทรคมนาคมและอปกรณนี
มีความสอดคลองตามมาตรฐานหรอขอก
าหนดทางเทคนคของ
กสทช
.
Regulatory notices for telecommunication terminal equipment
Regulatory notices for telecommunication terminal equipment
This section contains regulatory information pertaining to products that contain the analog facsimile card:
Lexmark Regulatory Type/Model Number:
LEX-M14-002 or LEX-M03-002
Notice to users of the US telephone network: FCC requirements
This equipment complies with Part 68 of the FCC rules and the requirements adopted by the Administrative
Council for Terminal Attachments (ACTA). On the back of this equipment is a label that contains, among other
information, a product identifier in the format US:AAAEQ##TXXXX. If requested, this number must be provided
to your telephone company.
This equipment uses the RJ-11C Universal Service Order Code (USOC) jack.
A plug and jack used to connect this equipment to the premises’ wiring and telephone network must comply
with the applicable FCC Part 68 rules and requirements adopted by the ACTA. Use a compliant telephone cord
(RJ-11) that is 26 AWG or larger when connecting this product to the public switched telephone network. See
your setup documentation for more information.
The Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) is used to determine the number of devices that may be connected to
a telephone line. Excessive RENs on a telephone line may result in the devices not ringing in response to an
incoming call. In most but not all areas, the sum of RENs should not exceed five (5.0). To be certain of the number
of devices that may be connected to a line, as determined by the total RENs, contact your local telephone
company. For products approved after July 23, 2001, the REN for this product is part of the product
identifier
that has the format US:AAAEQ##TXXXX. The digits represented by ## are the REN without a decimal point
(for example, 03 is a REN of 0.3). For earlier products, the REN is shown separately on the label.
If this equipment causes harm to the telephone network, the telephone company will notify you in advance that
temporary discontinuance of service may be required. If advance notice is not practical, the telephone company
will notify the customer as soon as possible. You will also be advised of your right to
file
a complaint with the
FCC.
The telephone company may make changes in its facilities, equipment, operations or procedures that could
aect the operation of this equipment. If this happens, the telephone company will provide advance notice in
order for you to make necessary
modifications
to maintain uninterrupted service.
If you experience trouble with this equipment, for repair or warranty information, contact Lexmark International,
Inc. at
www.lexmark.com or your Lexmark representative. If the equipment is causing harm to the telephone
network, the telephone company may request that you disconnect the equipment until the problem is resolved.
Notices 351
background
This equipment contains no user serviceable parts. For repair and warranty information, contact Lexmark
International, Inc. See the previous paragraph for contact information.
Connection to party line service is subject to state taris. Contact the state public utility commission, public
service commission, or corporation commission for information.
If your home has specially wired alarm equipment connected to the telephone line, ensure the installation of
this equipment does not disable your alarm equipment. If you have questions about what will disable alarm
equipment, consult your telephone company or a qualified installer.
The Telephone Consumer Protection Act of 1991 makes it unlawful for any person to use a computer or other
electronic device, including fax machines, to send any message unless said message clearly contains in a
margin at the top or bottom of each transmitted page or on the first page of the transmission, the date and time
it is sent and an identification of the business or other entity, or other individual sending the message, and the
telephone number of the sending machine or such business, other entity, or individual. (The telephone number
provided may not be a 900 number or any other number for which charges exceed local or long-distance
transmission charges.)
See your user documentation in order to program this information into your fax machine.
Notice to users of the Canadian telephone network
This product meets the applicable Innovation, Science and Economic Development Canada technical
specifications.
The Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) indicates the maximum number of devices allowed to be connected to
a telephone interface. The termination of an interface may consist of any combination of devices subject only
to the requirement that the sum of the RENs of all the devices not exceed five. The REN is located on the product
label.
This equipment uses CA11A telephone jacks.
Avis réservé aux utilisateurs du réseau téléphonique du Canada
Ce produit est conforme aux
spécifications
techniques d’Innovation, Sciences et Développement économique
Canada.
Le numéro REN (ringer equivalence number : numéro d’équivalence de sonnerie) indique le nombre maximum
d'appareils pouvant être connectés à l’interface téléphonique. En bout de ligne, le nombre d’appareils qui
peuvent être connectés n’est pas directement limité, mais la somme des REN de ces appareils ne doit pas
dépasser cinq. Le numéro REN est indiqué sur l'étiquette produit.
Cet équipement utilise des prises de téléphone CA11A.
Notice to users of the New Zealand telephone network
The following are special conditions for the Facsimile User Instructions. The grant of a telepermit for any item
of terminal equipment indicates only that Spark has accepted that the item complies with minimum conditions
for connection to its network. It indicates no endorsement of the product by Spark, nor does it provide any sort
of warranty. Above all, it provides no assurance that any item will work correctly in all respects with another
item of telepermitted equipment of a dierent make or model, nor does it imply that any product is compatible
with all of Spark's network services.
This equipment shall not be set up to make automatic calls to the Spark “111” Emergency Service.
Notices 352
background
This equipment may not provide for the eective hand-over of a call to another device connected to the same
line.
This equipment should not be used under any circumstances that may constitute a nuisance to other Spark
customers.
This equipment is not capable, under all operating conditions, of correct operation at the higher speeds for
which it is designed. Spark will accept no responsibility should diculties arise in such circumstances.
The decadic (or pulse) dialing on this device is unsuitable for use on the Spark network in New Zealand.
For correct operation, the total of all the Ringer Equivalence Numbers (RENs) of all parallel devices connected
to the same telephone line may not exceed 5. The REN of this device is located on the label.
This device uses an RJ-11C modular connector. Contact your point of purchase if a BT adapter is required. The
Lexmark part number is 80D1873.
Some parameters required for compliance with Spark's telepermit requirements are dependent on the
equipment associated with this device. The associated equipment shall be set to operate within the following
limits for compliance to Spark's specifications:
There shall be no more than 10 call attempts to the same number within any 30 minute period for any single
manual call initiation, and
The equipment shall go on-hook for a period of not less than 30 seconds between the end of one attempt
and the beginning of the next call attempt.
The equipment shall be set to ensure that automatic calls to
dierent
numbers are spaced such that there
is not less than 5 seconds between the end of one call attempt and the beginning of another.
Japanese telecom notice
The installed optional modem is in compliance with Japanese Telecommunication Law and has been Certified
by JATE, with the following Certification Number:
A18-0046001 or A11-0160001JP
Lexmark International, Inc.
LEX-M14-002 or LEX-M03-002
A18-0046001 or A11-0160001JP
Using this product in Switzerland
This product requires a Swiss billing tone filter (Lexmark part number 80D1877) to be installed on any line which
receives metering pulses in Switzerland.
Utilisation de ce produit en Suisse
Cet appareil nécessite l’utilisation d’un filtre de tonalité de facturation suisse (nº de référence Lexmark :
80D1877) devant être installé sur toute ligne recevant des impulsions de comptage en Suisse.
Notices 353
background
Verwendung dieses Produkts in der Schweiz
Für dieses Produkt muss ein schweizerischer Billing Tone Filter zur Zählzeichenübertragung (Lexmark
Teilenummer 80D1877) für jede Leitung installiert werden, über die in der Schweiz Zeitsteuertakte übertragen
werden.
Uso del prodotto in Svizzera
Questo prodotto richiede un filtro toni Billing svizzero, (codice Lexmark 80D1877) da installare su tutte le linee
che ricevono impulsi remoti in Svizzera.
Federal Communications Commission (FCC) compliance information
statement
This product has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital device, pursuant to Part
15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause harmful
interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause
undesired operation.
The FCC Class A limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the
equipment is operated in a commercial environment. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio
frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual, may cause harmful
interference to radio communications. Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to cause harmful
interference, in which case the user will be required to correct the interference at his own expense.
The manufacturer is not responsible for any radio or television interference caused by using other than
recommended cables or by unauthorized changes or modifications to this equipment. Unauthorized changes
or modifications could void the user's authority to operate this equipment.
Note: To assure compliance with FCC regulations on electromagnetic interference for a Class A computing
device, use a properly shielded and grounded cable such as Lexmark part number 1021231 for parallel attach
or 1021294 for USB attach. Use of a substitute cable not properly shielded and grounded may result in a
violation of FCC regulations.
Any questions regarding this compliance information statement should be directed to:
Director of Lexmark Technology & Services
Lexmark International, Inc.
740 West New Circle Road
Lexington, KY 40550
Telephone: (859) 232–2000
Innovation, Science and Economic Development Canada compliance
statement
This Class A digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian Interference-Causing Equipment
Standard ICES-003.
Notices 354
background
Avis de conformité aux normes de l’Innovation, Sciences et
Développement économique Canada
Cet appareil numérique de classe A est conforme aux exigences de la norme canadienne relative aux
équipements pouvant causer des interférences NMB-003.
European Community (EC) directives conformity
This product is in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directives 2014/30/EU, 2014/35/EU,
and 2011/65/EU as amended by (EU) 2015/863 on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of the
Member States relating to electromagnetic compatibility, safety of electrical equipment designed for use within
certain voltage limits, and on the restrictions of use of certain hazardous substances in electrical and electronic
equipment.
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY,
40550 USA. The EEA/EU authorized representative is: Lexmark International Technology Hungária Kft., 8
Lechner Ödön fasor, Millennium Tower III, 1095 Budapest HUNGARY. The EEA/EU Importer is: Lexmark
International Technology S.à.r.l. 20, Route de Pré-Bois, ICC Building, Bloc A, CH-1215 Genève, Switzerland. A
declaration of conformity to the requirements of the Directives is available upon request from the Authorized
Representative or may be obtained at
www.lexmark.com/en_us/about/regulatory-compliance/european-union-declaration-of-conformity.html.
This product satisfies the Class A limits of EN 55032 and safety requirements of EN 62368-1.
United Kingdom (UK) conformity
United Kingdom (UK) conformity
This product is in conformity with the protection requirements of the Electromagnetic Compatibility Regulations
2016, the Electrical Equipment (Safety) Regulations 2016, and the Restriction of the Use of Certain Hazardous
Substances in Electrical and Electronic Equipment Regulations 2012.
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY,
40550 USA. The UK Importer is: Lexmark International Ltd, Quantum House, 60 Norden Road, Maidenhead
SL6 4AY, United Kingdom. A declaration of conformity is available upon request from the UK Importer or may
be obtained at
www.lexmark.com/en_us/about/regulatory-compliance/uk-declaration-of-conformity.html.
This product satisfies the Class A limits of BS EN 55032 and safety requirements of BS EN 62368-1.
Radio interference notice
Warning
This is a product that complies with the emission requirements of EN 55032 Class A limits and immunity
requirements of EN 55035. This product is not intended to be used in residential/domestic environments.
This is a Class A product. In a domestic environment, this product may cause radio interference, in which case
the user may be required to take adequate measures.
Notices 355
background
STATEMENT OF LIMITED WARRANTY FOR LEXMARK LASER PRINTERS, LEXMARK LED PRINTERS, AND
LEXMARK MULTIFUNCTION LASER PRINTERS
STATEMENT OF LIMITED WARRANTY FOR LEXMARK LASER PRINTERS,
LEXMARK LED PRINTERS, AND LEXMARK MULTIFUNCTION LASER
PRINTERS
Lexmark International, Inc., Lexington, KY
This limited warranty applies to the United States and Canada. For customers outside the U.S., refer to the
country-specific warranty information that came with your product.
This limited warranty applies to this product only if it was originally purchased for your use, and not for resale,
from Lexmark or a Lexmark Remarketer, referred to in this statement as “Remarketer.
Limited warranty
Lexmark warrants that this product:
—Is manufactured from new parts, or new and serviceable used parts, which perform like new parts
—Is, during normal use, free from defects in material and workmanship
If this product does not function as warranted during the warranty period, contact a Remarketer or Lexmark for
repair or replacement (at Lexmark's option).
If this product is a feature or option, this statement applies only when that feature or option is used with the
product for which it was intended. To obtain warranty service, you may be required to present the feature or
option with the product.
If you transfer this product to another user, warranty service under the terms of this statement is available to
that user for the remainder of the warranty period. You should transfer proof of original purchase and this
statement to that user.
Limited warranty service
The warranty period starts on the date of original purchase as shown on the purchase receipt and ends 12
months later provided that the warranty period for any supplies and for any maintenance items included with
the printer shall end earlier if it, or its original contents, are substantially used up, depleted, or consumed. Fuser
Units, Transfer/Transport Units, Paper Feed items, if any, and any other items for which a Maintenance Kit is
available are substantially consumed when the printer displays a “Life Warning” or “Scheduled Maintenance
message for such item.
To obtain warranty service you may be required to present proof of original purchase. You may be required to
deliver your product to the Remarketer or Lexmark, or ship it prepaid and suitably packaged to a Lexmark
designated location. You are responsible for loss of, or damage to, a product in transit to the Remarketer or the
Lexmark designated location.
When warranty service involves the exchange of a product or part, the item replaced becomes the property of
the Remarketer or Lexmark. The replacement may be a new or repaired item.
The replacement item assumes the remaining warranty period of the original product.
Notices 356
background
Replacement is not available to you if the product you present for exchange is defaced, altered, in need of a
repair not included in warranty service, damaged beyond repair, or if the product is not free of all legal
obligations, restrictions, liens, and encumbrances.
As part of your warranty service and/or replacement, Lexmark may update the firmware in your printer to the
latest version. Firmware updates may modify printer settings and cause counterfeit and/or unauthorized
products, supplies, parts, materials (such as toners and inks), software, or interfaces to stop working. Authorized
use of genuine Lexmark products will not be impacted.
Before you present this product for warranty service, remove all print cartridges, programs, data, and removable
storage media (unless directed otherwise by Lexmark).
For further explanation of your warranty alternatives and the nearest Lexmark authorized servicer in your area
contact Lexmark on the World Wide Web.
Remote technical support is provided for this product throughout its warranty period. For products no longer
covered by a Lexmark warranty, technical support may not be available or only be available for a fee.
Extent of limited warranty
Lexmark does not warrant uninterrupted or error-free operation of any product or the durability or longevity of
prints produced by any product.
Warranty service does not include repair of failures caused by:
—Modification or unauthorized attachments
—Accidents, misuse, abuse or use inconsistent with Lexmark user’s guides, manuals, instructions or guidance
—Unsuitable physical or operating environment
—Maintenance by anyone other than Lexmark or a Lexmark authorized servicer
—Operation of a product beyond the limit of its duty cycle
—Use of printing media outside of Lexmark specifications
—Refurbishment, repair, refilling or remanufacture by a third party of products, supplies or parts
—Products, supplies, parts, materials (such as toners and inks), software, or interfaces not furnished by Lexmark
TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, NEITHER LEXMARK NOR ITS THIRD PARTY SUPPLIERS
OR REMARKETERS MAKE ANY OTHER WARRANTY OR CONDITION OF ANY KIND, WHETHER EXPRESS
OR IMPLIED, WITH RESPECT TO THIS PRODUCT, AND SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIM THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, AND
SATISFACTORY QUALITY. ANY WARRANTIES THAT MAY NOT BE DISCLAIMED UNDER APPLICABLE LAW
ARE LIMITED IN DURATION TO THE WARRANTY PERIOD. NO WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WILL
APPLY AFTER THIS PERIOD. ALL INFORMATION, SPECIFICATIONS, PRICES, AND SERVICES ARE SUBJECT
TO CHANGE AT ANY TIME WITHOUT NOTICE.
Limitation of liability
Your sole remedy under this limited warranty is set forth in this document. For any claim concerning performance
or nonperformance of Lexmark or a Remarketer for this product under this limited warranty, you may recover
actual damages up to the limit set forth in the following paragraph.
Lexmark's liability for actual damages from any cause whatsoever will be limited to the amount you paid for the
product that caused the damages. This limitation of liability will not apply to claims by you for bodily injury or
damage to real property or tangible personal property for which Lexmark is legally liable. IN NO EVENT WILL
Notices 357
background
LEXMARK BE LIABLE FOR ANY LOST PROFITS, LOST SAVINGS, INCIDENTAL DAMAGE, OR OTHER
ECONOMIC OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES. This is true even if you advise Lexmark or a Remarketer of the
possibility of such damages. Lexmark is not liable for any claim by you based on a third party claim.
This limitation of remedies also applies to claims against any Suppliers and Remarketers of Lexmark. Lexmark's
and its Suppliers' and Remarketers' limitations of remedies are not cumulative. Such Suppliers and Remarketers
are intended beneficiaries of this limitation.
Additional rights
Some states do not allow limitations on how long an implied warranty lasts, or do not allow the exclusion or
limitation of incidental or consequential damages, so the limitations or exclusions contained above may not
apply to you.
This limited warranty gives you specific legal rights. You may also have other rights that vary from state to state.
Notices 358
background
Index
A
activating Voice Guidance 28
adapter plug 38
adding a shortcut
copy 111
adding apps to home screen 23
adding contact groups 27
adding contacts 27
adding hardware options
print driver 56
adding internal options
print driver 56
adding printers to a computer 55
adding shortcut
email 112
fax destination 114
FTP address 118
Address Book
using 27
ADF pick roller
cleaning 256
replacing 244
ADF registration
adjusting 338
ADF rollers
cleaning 256
replacing 244
ADF separator roller
cleaning 256
replacing 244
adjusting
scanner registration 338
adjusting ADF registration 338
adjusting brightness
of display 261
adjusting default volume
headphone 33
speaker 33
adjusting fax darkness 114
adjusting speech rate
Voice Guidance 33
adjusting toner darkness 108
AirPrint
using 104
analog fax
setting up 34
answering machine
setting up 36
assigning printer to a ring
pattern 40
attaching cables 21
avoiding paper jams 306
B
black images 287
black imaging unit
ordering 210
replacing 214
blank pages 273
blocking junk faxes 115
bookmarks
creating 26
creating folders for 27
C
caller ID is not shown 326
canceling a print job 108
cannot connect printer to
WiFi 317
cannot open Embedded Web
Server 316
cannot receive faxes using
analog fax 329
cannot scan to a computer 332
cannot scan to a network
folder 333
cannot send emails 326
cannot send or receive faxes
using analog fax 327
cannot send or receive faxes
using etherFAX 330
cannot send the fax cover page
from the computer 331
Card Copy
setting up 24
card stock
loading 52
cards
copying 111
changing fax resolution 114
changing the printer port settings
after installing ISP 77
changing the wallpaper 25
checking the status of parts and
supplies 207
cleaning
exterior of the printer 249
interior of the printer 249
pick tires 252
cleaning pick roller in the
multipurpose feeder 254
cleaning the ADF pick roller 256
cleaning the ADF rollers 256
cleaning the ADF separator
roller 256
cleaning the printer 249
Cleaning the Scanner 206
cleaning the scanner 250
cleaning the touch screen 249
clearing jam
behind door A 311
in automatic document
feeder 310
in the duplex area 311
in the fuser area 311
in the multipurpose feeder 310
in the standard bin 311
in trays 309
collated printing does not
work 323
collating copies 110
color correction 339
color imaging kit
ordering 210
replacing 223
color quality, troubleshooting
print appears tinted 341
colored background on print 278
computer
connecting to the printer 99
computer, scanning to 117
confidential documents do not
print 301
confidential
print jobs
configuring 106
printing 107
configuring
daylight saving
time 40
configuring fax speaker
settings 40
configuring
supply
notifications
207
Index 359
background
configuring the email server
settings 40
configuring WiFi Direct 98
connecting a computer to the
printer 99
connecting mobile device
to printer 99
connecting printer to distinctive
ring service 40
connecting the printer
to a wireless network 97
connecting to a wireless network
using PIN method 97
using Push Button method 97
conserving supplies 261
contacting customer support 341
control panel
using 11
convenience stapler
installing 81
red indicator light 321
copy troubleshooting
partial copies of documents or
photos 334
poor copy quality 335
scanner does not respond 338
copying
cards 111
on both sides of the paper 110
on letterhead 110
photos 109
using the automatic document
feeder (ADF) 109
using the scanner glass 109
copying dierent paper
sizes 109
copying from
selected tray 109
copying multiple pages
onto a single sheet 111
creating a shortcut
copy 111
network folder 119
creating bookmarks 26
creating folders
for bookmarks 27
creating shortcut
email 112
fax destination 114
FTP address 118
creating shortcuts 24
crooked print 286
Customer Support
using 25
customer support
contacting 341
customizing the display 25
D
dark print 275
date and time
fax settings 40
daylight saving time
configuring 40
deactivating the WiFi
network 100
deactivating Voice Guidance 28
default headphone volume
adjusting 33
default speaker volume
adjusting 33
defective intelligent storage
drive 320
deleting contact groups 27
deleting contacts 27
Device Quotas
setting up 26
dierent paper sizes,
copying 109
directory list
printing 108
display brightness
adjusting 261
Display Customization
using 25
displaying apps on home
screen 23
distinctive ring service, fax
enabling 40
documents, printing
from a computer 103
from a mobile device 103
dots on printed page 284
E
editing contacts 27
emission notices 344, 0
enabling
Magnification
mode 32
enabling personal
identification
numbers 33
enabling spoken passwords 33
enabling the USB port 306
enabling WiFi Direct 99
enlarging a copy size 110
envelope seals when
printing 323
envelopes
loading 52
environmental settings 261
erasing printer memory 101, 102
erasing printer storage drive 101
error codes 264
error message
SMTP server not set up 325
error messages 264
etherFAX
setting up fax function 35
Ethernet cable 21
Ethernet port 21
exporting a configuration file
using the Embedded Web
Server 56
email
sending 112
email alerts
setting up 207
email function
setting up 40
email server
configuring 40
email service providers 40
email shortcut
creating 112
email troubleshooting
cannot send emails 326
emailing
using the automatic document
feeder (ADF) 112
using the scanner glass 112
F
factory default settings
restoring 102
FAQ about color printing 340
fax
forwarding 115
holding 115
sending 113
fax card
installing 67
fax darkness
adjusting 114
fax destination shortcut
creating 114
Index 360
background
fax driver
installing 55
fax log
printing 115
fax resolution
changing 114
fax server, using
setting up the fax function 36
fax setup
country or regionspecific 38
standard telephone line
connection 36
fax speaker settings
configuring 40
fax troubleshooting
caller ID is not shown 326
can send but not receive faxes
using analog fax 329
cannot send faxes using analog
fax 329
cannot send or receive faxes
using analog fax 327
cannot send or receive faxes
using etherFAX 330
cannot send the fax cover page
from the computer 331
cannot set up etherFAX 329
missing information on the fax
cover page 331
poor print quality 331
fax, scheduling 114
faxing
setting the date and time 40
using the automatic document
feeder (ADF) 113
using the scanner glass 113
file types
supported 106
finding printer information 9
finding the printer serial
number 10
firmware, updating
using the control panel 57
using the Embedded Web
Server 58
flash drive
printing from 105
scanning to 120
flash drives
supported 106
font sample list
printing 108
forwarding fax 115
FTP address
creating shortcut 118
FTP server, scanning to
using the control panel 118
fuser
replacing 234
fuser maintenance kit
ordering 210
G
genuine Lexmark parts and
supplies 208
genuine parts and supplies 208
ghost images 277
gray background on print 278
H
hard disk
erasing 101
hard disk storage drive 102
hardware options
trays 59
hardware options, adding
print driver 56
held documents do not print 301
held jobs
printing 107
setting expiration time 106
Hibernate mode
configuring
261
holding faxes 115
home screen
customizing 23
using 22
home screen icons
displaying 23
horizontal dark lines 292
horizontal white lines 294
humidity around the printer 348
I
icons on the home screen
showing 23
images cut o on print 288
importing a configuration file
using the Embedded Web
Server 56
incorrect margins 279
indicator light
understanding the status 12
installing internal options
fax card 67
intelligent storage drive 60
Trusted Platform Module 64
installing options
internal solutions port 72
printer hard disk 78
installing the convenience
stapler 81
installing the fax driver 55
installing the print driver 54
installing the printer software 54
installing trays 59
installing wireless print
server 87, 93, 95
intelligent storage drive 58, 102
erasing 101
installing 60
internal option is not
detected 318
internal options 58
internal options, adding
print driver 56
internal solutions port 58
installing 72
troubleshooting 319
J
jagged image
scanning from the ADF 336
jagged text
scanning from the ADF 336
jam areas
locating 307
jam, clearing
in the multipurpose feeder 310
in the standard bin 311
jammed pages are not
reprinted 325
jams, paper
avoiding 306
job prints from the wrong
tray 302
job prints on the wrong
paper 302
junk faxes
blocking 115
L
letterhead
copying on 110
Index 361
background
selecting 14
Lexmark Mobile Print
using 103
Lexmark Print
using 103
Lexmark ScanBack Utility
using 117
light print 279
linking trays 54
loading
card stock 52
envelopes 52
multipurpose feeder 52
loading trays 49
locating jam areas 307
locating the security slot 101
M
Magnification mode
enabling 32
maintenance counter
resetting 248
making copies 109
managing screen saver 25
manual color correction 339
MarkNet N8370 Wireless Print
Server 87
MarkNet N8372 Wireless Print
Server 93
MarkNet N8450 Wireless Print
Server 95
menu
802.1x 192
About this Printer 137
Accessibility 129
Anonymous Data
Collection 129
Cloud Services Enrollment 204
Confidential Print Setup 201
Configuration
Menu 131
Copy Defaults 149
Custom Scan Sizes 148
Default Login Methods 198
Device 204
Disk Encryption 202
EcoMode 123
Erase Temporary Data
Files 202
Ethernet 187
Email Defaults 169
Email Setup 168
Fax 205
Fax Mode 152
Fax Server Setup 164
Fax Setup 153
Flash Drive Print 181
Flash Drive Scan 178
FTP Defaults 174
Home Screen
Customization 136
HTTP/FTP Settings 194
Image 146
IPSec 191
Job Accounting 142
Layout 138
Local Accounts 197
Login Restrictions 201
LPD Configuration 193
Manage Permissions 196
Media Types 148
Menu Settings Page 204
Miscellaneous 203
Mobile Services
Management 187
Network 206
Network Overview 183
Notifications 125
Out of Service Erase 136
PCL 144
PDF 143
PostScript 143
Power Management 128
Preferences 122
Print 205
Quality 140
Remote Operator Panel 124
Restore Factory Defaults 130
Restrict external network
access 195
Schedule USB Devices 198
Security Audit Log 199
Setup 139
Shortcuts 205
SNMP 190
Solutions LDAP Settings 203
TCP/IP 188
ThinPrint 194
Tray Conguration 146
Troubleshooting 206
Universal Setup 147
Update firmware 137
USB 195
Web Link Setup 174
Wireless 184
WiFi Direct 186
Menu Settings Page
printing 206
missing colors 282
missing information on the fax
cover page 331
mobile device
connecting to printer 99
printing from 103, 104
modifying color output 339
Mopria Print Service 104
mottled print and dots 284
moving the printer 20, 261
Multiple Universal Sizes
enabling 49
multipurpose feeder
loading 52
N
navigating the screen
using gestures 28
network folder
creating a shortcut 119
network setup page
printing 100
noise emission levels 344
nonvolatile memory
erasing 101
NonLexmark supply 322
nonvolatile memory 102
Not enough free space in flash
memory for resources 320
notices 344, 347, 349, 350, 0
O
onscreen keyboard
using 32
ordering supplies
black imaging unit 210
color imaging kit 210
fuser maintenance kit 210
toner cartridge 208
waste toner bottle 210
P
paper
letterhead 14
preprinted forms 14
selecting 12
unacceptable 13
Universal size setting 48
Index 362
background
paper characteristics 12
paper frequently jams 324
paper guidelines 12
paper jam
behind door A 311
in automatic document
feeder 310
in the duplex area 311
in the fuser area 311
in the multipurpose feeder 310
in the standard bin 311
in trays 309
paper jams
avoiding 306
paper size
setting 48
paper sizes
supported 15
paper type
setting 48
paper types
supported 18
paper weights
supported 19
parallel interface card
troubleshooting 320
parts status
checking 207
personal identification numbers
enabling 33
photos, copying 109
pick roller
replacing 236
pick roller in the multipurpose
feeder
cleaning 254
pick tires
cleaning 252
placing separator sheets 108
placing separator sheets
between copies
copying 110
poor fax print quality 331
power cord socket 21
power save modes
configuring 261
preprinted forms
selecting 14
print appears tinted 341
print driver
hardware options, adding 56
installing 54
print job
canceling 108
print jobs not printed 300
print quality problem
blank pages 273
images cut o on print 288
light print 279
missing colors 282
repeating print defects 297
text cut o on print 288
white pages 273
Print Quality Test Pages 206
print quality troubleshooting
crooked print 286
dark print 275
ghost images appear on
prints 277
gray or colored
background 278
horizontal dark lines 292
horizontal white lines 294
mottled print and dots 284
paper curl 285
skewed print 286
solid color or black images 287
toner easily rubs o 290
uneven print density 291
vertical dark lines appear on
prints 293
vertical white lines 295
print troubleshooting
collated printing does not
work 323
confidential and other held
documents do not print 301
envelope seals when
printing 323
incorrect margins 279
job prints from the wrong
tray 302
job prints on the wrong
paper 302
paper frequently jams 324
print jobs do not print 300
slow printing 302
tray linking does not work 324
unable to read flash drive 305
printer
minimum clearances 20
selecting a location for 20
shipping 262
printer configurations 10
printer error codes 264
printer error messages 264
printer hard disk 58
installing 78
printer information
finding 9
printer is not responding 304
printer memory
erasing 101
printer menus 121, 206
printer messages
Defective flash detected 320
NonLexmark supply 322
Not enough free space in flash
memory for resources 320
Replace cartridge, printer region
mismatch 321
printer options troubleshooting
cannot detect internal
option 318
internal solutions port 319
parallel interface card 320
serial interface card 320
printer port settings
changing 77
printer ports 21
printer settings
restoring factory default 102
printer software
installing 54
printer status 12
printing
confidential print jobs 107
directory list 108
font sample list 108
from a computer 103
from a flash drive 105
from a mobile device 104
held jobs 107
Menu Settings Page 206
network setup page 100
using Mopria Print Service 104
using WiFi Direct 104
printing a directory list 108
printing a fax log 115
printing a font sample list 108
printing a network setup
page 100
printing from a computer 103
Index 363
background
R
received faxes
holding 115
recycling
Lexmark packaging 342
Lexmark products 342
red indicator light
on the convenience stapler 321
reducing a copy size 110
removing jam
behind door A 311
in the duplex area 311
in the fuser area 311
removing paper jam
in automatic document
feeder 310
in trays 309
repeat print jobs 106
repeating print defects 297
Replace cartridge, printer region
mismatch 321
replacing parts
ADF pick roller 244
ADF rollers 244
ADF separator roller 244
fuser 234
pick roller 236
separator bracket 240
replacing supplies
black imaging unit 214
color imaging kit 223
scanner glass pad 242
toner cartridge 211
waste toner bottle 232
reports
printer status 208
printer usage 208
resetting
supply usage counters 322
resetting supply usage
counters 249
resetting the maintenance
counter 248
resetting the supply usage
counters 322
RJ11 adapter 38
running a slideshow 25
S
safety information 7, 8
saving paper 111
saving toner 111
Scan Center
setting up 24
scan troubleshooting
cannot scan to a computer 332
cannot scan to network
folder 333
jagged image when scanning
from the ADF 336
jagged text when scanning from
the ADF 336
partial copies of documents or
photos 334
poor copy quality 335
scan job was not
successful 337
scanner does not respond 338
scanning freezes the
computer 337
scanning takes too long 337
vertical dark streaks on output
when scanning from the
ADF 335
scanner
cleaning 250
scanner does not close 337
scanner glass pad
replacing 242
scanning
to a computer 117
to an FTP server 118
to flash drive 120
using the automatic document
feeder (ADF) 117
using the scanner glass 117
scanning from ADF
jagged image 336
jagged text 336
scanning quality problem 335
scanning to a network folder 119
scanning to an FTP server
using the control panel 118
scheduling a fax 114
screen gestures 28
securing printer data 102
security slot
locating 101
selecting location
for the printer 20
sending email 112
sending fax 113
separator bracket
replacing 240
separator sheets
placing 108
serial interface card
troubleshooting 320
serial number, printer
finding 10
serial printing
setting up 100
setting paper size
Multiple Universal Sizes 49
setting the paper size 48
setting the paper type 48
setting the Universal paper
size 48
setting up
analog fax 34
setting up Device Quotas 26
setting up email alerts 207
setting up fax
country or regionspecific 38
standard telephone line
connection 36
setting up fax function
using etherFAX 35
setting up serial printing 100
setting up the fax function using
fax server 36
shipping the printer 262
shortcut
Copy 24
Email 24
Fax 24
FTP 24
shortcut, creating
email 112
fax destination 114
FTP address 118
shortcut, creating a
copy 111
shortcuts
creating 24
skewed print 286
Sleep mode
configuring 261
slow printing 302
SMB
scanning 119
SMTP server not set up 325
SMTP settings
configuring 40
Index 364
background
solid color 287
sorting multiple copies 110
spoken passwords
enabling 33
statement of volatility 102
storage drive
erasing 101
storing paper 14
storing print jobs 106
supplies
conserving 261
supplies status
checking 207
supply notifications
configuring 207
supply usage counters
resetting 249, 322
supported applications 23
supported fax 33
supported file types 106
supported flash drives 106
supported paper sizes 15
supported paper types 18
supported paper weights 19
T
temperature around the
printer 348
text cut
o
on print 288
toner cartridge
ordering 208
replacing 211
toner darkness
adjusting 108
toner easily rubs o 290
touch screen
cleaning 249
touchscreen gestures 28
trays
installing 59
linking 54
loading 49
unlinking 54
troubleshooting
cannot connect printer to
WiFi 317
cannot open Embedded Web
Server 316
FAQ about color printing 340
printer is not responding 304
SMTP server not set up 325
troubleshooting, color quality
print appears tinted 341
troubleshooting, copy
partial copies of documents or
photos 334
poor copy quality 335
scanner does not close 337
scanner does not respond 338
troubleshooting, email
cannot send emails 326
troubleshooting, fax
caller ID is not shown 326
can send but not receive faxes
using analog fax 329
cannot send faxes using analog
fax 329
cannot send or receive faxes
using analog fax 327
cannot send or receive faxes
using etherFAX 330
cannot send the fax cover page
from the computer 331
cannot set up etherFAX 329
missing information on the fax
cover page 331
poor print quality 331
troubleshooting, print
collated printing does not
work 323
confidential and other held
documents do not print 301
envelope seals when
printing 323
incorrect margins 279
jammed pages are not
reprinted 325
job prints from the wrong
tray 302
job prints on the wrong
paper 302
paper frequently jams 324
print jobs do not print 300
slow printing 302
tray linking does not work 324
troubleshooting, print quality
crooked print 286
dark print 275
ghost images appear on
prints 277
gray or colored
background 278
horizontal dark lines 292
horizontal white lines 294
mottled print and dots 284
paper curl 285
skewed print 286
solid color or black images 287
toner easily rubs o 290
uneven print density 291
vertical dark lines appear on
prints 293
vertical white lines 295
troubleshooting, printer options
cannot detect internal
option 318
internal solutions port 319
troubleshooting, scan
cannot scan to a computer 332
cannot scan to a network
folder 333
jagged image when scanning
from the ADF 336
jagged text when scanning from
the ADF 336
partial copies of documents or
photos 334
poor copy quality 335
scan job was not
successful 337
scanner does not close 337
scanner does not respond 338
vertical dark streaks on output
when scanning from the
ADF 335
Trusted Platform Module
installing 64
twosided copying 110
U
unable to read flash drive
troubleshooting, print 305
uneven print density 291
Universal paper size
setting 48
unlinking trays 54
updating
firmware
using the control panel 57
using the Embedded Web
Server 58
USB cable 21
USB port 21
enabling 306
using Customer Support 25
using Display Customization 25
Index 365
background
using genuine Lexmark parts and
supplies 208
using the ADF
copying 109
using the control panel 11
using the home screen 22
using the scanner glass
copying 109
V
verify print jobs 106
vertical dark lines on prints 293
vertical dark streaks on output
when scanning from the
ADF 335
vertical white lines 295
viewing reports 208
Voice Guidance
activating 28
deactivating 28
speech rate 33
Voice Guidance speech rate
adjusting 33
volatile memory 102
erasing 101
W
waste toner bottle
ordering 210
replacing 232
white pages 273
wireless network
connecting the printer to 97
wireless networking 97
wireless print server 58
installing 87, 93, 95
WiFi Direct
configuring 98
enabling 99
printing from a mobile
device 104
WiFi network
deactivating 100
WiFi Protected Setup
configuring 97
Index 366

Specifications

Lexmark CX730DE Questions and Answers

Questions and Answers

Related Products

Product Lexmark CS725 image
Lexmark CS725
2025-12-29 16 docs
Product Lexmark CX725 image
Lexmark CX725
2025-12-29 16 docs
Product Lexmark CX727DE image
Lexmark CX727DE
2025-12-11 14 docs
Product Lexmark CX725DTHE image
Lexmark CX725DTHE
2025-12-11 16 docs
Product Lexmark CX725DHE image
Lexmark CX725DHE
2025-12-11 16 docs
Product Lexmark CX725DE image
Lexmark CX725DE
2025-12-11 16 docs